(define-ibuffer-filter filename): If `dired-directory' is a list, use its car.
[bpt/emacs.git] / etc / NEWS
CommitLineData
c67de8ba 1GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
73a6a972
SM
2Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
a933dad1
DL
4See the end for copying conditions.
5
6Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
3787e12e 7For older news, see the file ONEWS
5a2c89c3
JL
8You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
9`view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
a933dad1 10
ad8d610b
KS
11Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
1a0b9ae4 15so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
ad8d610b 16
05197f40 17\f
bf247b6e 18* Installation Changes in Emacs 22.1
76fb24bb 19
7e995a23 20---
30b0da81
RS
21** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
22`--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
23installed programs.
1ebd4f78 24
bc83b22b 25---
30b0da81 26** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
bc83b22b 27
a775dff4 28---
0571f2d8 29** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
7bea57c9
DL
30when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
31provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
0571f2d8 32
a775dff4 33---
4208da83
SM
34** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with elisp code.
35
2b6bb1f2 36---
81f755ae 37** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
672ab90b 38scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
da9356b0 39place for game scores to be stored. You can control this with the
672ab90b
CW
40configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
41to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
5167cfda
CW
42to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
43in each user's home directory.
81f755ae 44
cd7d2d9e
EZ
45---
46** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
47You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
48Emacs with Leim.
49
4e5cdb4f
KS
50+++
51** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
52
406c0f12 53The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual in Info format is built as part of the
4e5cdb4f
KS
54Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
55Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
56accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
57
58---
59** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
60the distribution.
61
62This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
63together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
64item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
65(Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
66
30b0da81 67---
406c0f12 68** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the
fa2b23e5
KS
69following languages: Brasilian Portuguese, Bulgarian, Chinese (both
70with simplified and traditional characters), French, and Italian.
71Type `C-u C-h t' to choose one of them in case your language setup
72doesn't automatically select the right one.
30b0da81
RS
73
74---
75** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
76
77---
78** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand.
79(Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
80the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
81setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
82
a775dff4 83---
c60ee5e7
JB
84** Support for Cygwin was added.
85
a17b3614 86---
1096bcc0
GM
87** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
88
84913e36
EZ
89---
90** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
91
82e119fb
EZ
92---
93** Support for MacOS X was added.
94See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
95
2b6bb1f2 96---
3fa4ac47 97** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
16927a56 98
a775dff4 99---
561a8f98
YM
100** Mac OS 9 port now uses the Carbon API by default. You can also
101create non-Carbon build by specifying `NonCarbon' as a target. See
102the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
103
4e5cdb4f 104---
d7107586
SM
105** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
106types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
c44da964
RS
107
108---
109** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
110much pure storage it will approximately need.
4e5cdb4f 111\f
406c0f12 112* Startup Changes in Emacs 22.1
d2d70cb6 113
30b0da81
RS
114** New command line option -Q or --quick.
115This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
116the fancy startup screen.
40062616 117
c9a0bd66 118+++
30b0da81
RS
119** New command line option -D or --basic-display.
120Disables the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, and
121the blinking cursor.
c9a0bd66 122
6d42bedc 123+++
30b0da81
RS
124** New command line option -nbc or --no-blinking-cursor disables
125the blinking cursor on graphical terminals.
d3cd3365 126
f3c2dbe9
EZ
127+++
128** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
129It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
130can start with this line:
131
132 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
133
134+++
135** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
136Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
137appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
138
139 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
140
141Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
142in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
143
7e995a23 144+++
30b0da81
RS
145** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
146--no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
7e995a23 147
30b0da81
RS
148+++
149** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
150now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
151an interactively callable function.
7e995a23 152
da9356b0
RS
153+++
154** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
155all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
156affects the initial frame.
157
30b0da81
RS
158+++
159** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
160When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
161`--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
162whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
163screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
7c0d8896 164
30b0da81
RS
165+++
166** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
167arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
168disables the splash screen; see also the variable
169`inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
170`inhibit-splash-screen').
a5f25dcd 171
30b0da81
RS
172+++
173** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
174When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
175displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
a57e098f 176
30b0da81
RS
177+++
178** Init file changes
179You can now put the init files .emacs and .emacs_SHELL under
180~/.emacs.d or directly under ~. Emacs will find them in either place.
f4931aac 181
a775dff4 182+++
30b0da81
RS
183** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
184automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
185modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
186can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
187according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
c44da964
RS
188\f
189* Incompatible Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
190
191+++
192** M-g is now a prefix key.
193M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
194M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
195M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
196
197+++
198** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
199and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
200
201When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
202point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
203
204+++
205** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
206since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
207the operating system or your X server.
208
209+++
210** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
211
212+++
213** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
214(beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
215you about it.
216
217+++
218** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
219in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
220
221+++
222** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
223previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
224mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
225
226+++
227** The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
228have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
229
230+++
231** In incremental search, C-w is changed. M-%, C-M-w and C-M-y are special.
232
233See below under "incremental search changes".
234
235---
236** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
237
238Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
239of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
240directory with Dired.
241
242+++
243** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
244to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
245it remains unchanged.
246
247+++
248** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
249M-o M-o requests refontification.
250
251+++
252** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
bc8113ba 253
c44da964
RS
254See below for more details.
255
256+++
257** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
258control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
259by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
260too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
261doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
262special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
406c0f12
RS
263\f
264* Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
265
da9356b0
RS
266+++
267** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
268On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
269
a775dff4 270+++
5827e9d4 271** M-g is now a prefix key.
5827e9d4
KS
272M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
273M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
274M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
c7bd5d57 275
a775dff4 276+++
c44da964 277** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
bb96021a
RS
278and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
279
280When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
281point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
282
1db7dd46 283+++
30b0da81
RS
284** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
285since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
286the operating system or your X server.
1db7dd46
RS
287
288+++
c44da964 289** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
1db7dd46 290
414ac1a3
RS
291+++
292** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
d4d66807
LT
293(beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
294you about it.
414ac1a3 295
a775dff4 296+++
c44da964
RS
297** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
298in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
18819b0f 299
406c0f12 300+++
c44da964
RS
301** You can now switch buffers in a cyclic order with C-x C-left and
302(prev-buffer) and C-x C-right (next-buffer). C-x left and C-x right
303can be used as well.
304
305+++
306** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
307
308+++
309** M-SPC (just-one-space) when given a numeric argument N
310converts whitespace around point to N spaces.
406c0f12
RS
311
312---
313** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
314`insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
315
30b0da81
RS
316---
317** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
318By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
4ac3afb9 319
5086e75d 320+++
30b0da81
RS
321** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
322be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
323`yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
324of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
5086e75d 325
4d894c98 326+++
30b0da81
RS
327** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
328been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
329in Indented-Text mode.
4d894c98 330
7d01236c 331+++
c44da964 332** M-x setenv now expands environment variable references.
da9356b0 333
c44da964
RS
334Substrings of the form `$foo' and `${foo}' in the specified new value
335now refer to the value of environment variable foo. To include a `$'
336in the value, use `$$'.
da9356b0
RS
337
338+++
c44da964
RS
339** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
340understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
341`same-window'.
da9356b0
RS
342
343+++
344** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
345from the locale.
346
347** Mark command changes:
3fc3e0a6 348
a1bcf785 349+++
406c0f12 350*** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
30b0da81
RS
351previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
352mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
3fc3e0a6 353
a775dff4 354+++
c44da964
RS
355*** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times.
356
357If you type C-M-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h
358(mark-paragraph), or C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region
359extends each time, so you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC
360M-C-SPC, for example. This feature also works for
361mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to a key. It also extends the
362region when the mark is active in Transient Mark mode, regardless of
363the last command. To start a new region with one of marking commands
364in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the active region with C-g,
365or set the new mark with C-SPC.
9254ee5e 366
a775dff4 367+++
406c0f12 368*** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
c44da964 369
30b0da81
RS
370With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
371if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
372paragraphs.
44251fad 373
a775dff4 374+++
406c0f12 375*** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
30b0da81
RS
376mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
377region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
378want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
379ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
380command only.
8248b4ad 381
30b0da81
RS
382One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
383and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
384This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
385mark or the region.
8248b4ad 386
30b0da81
RS
387After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
388deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
389that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
390C-g.
21fb7588 391
c44da964
RS
392+++
393*** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
394`beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
395is already active in Transient Mark mode.
396
406c0f12
RS
397** Help command changes:
398
399+++
400*** Changes in C-h bindings:
401
402C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
403
404C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
405 that do not change:
406
407C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
408C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
409
410The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
411have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
412
413C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
414
415- C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
416 run by the key sequence.
417
418- C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
419 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
420 that command.
421
422For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
423to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
424
425- C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
426 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
427
428- C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
429 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
430
431- C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
432 new-kill-line is on C-k
433
434---
435*** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
436arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
437default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
438`help-default-arg-highlight'.
439
440+++
441*** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
442variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
443
444+++
445*** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
446preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
447hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
448preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
449hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
450enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
451anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node').
452
453+++
454*** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
455description various information about a character, including its
456encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
457widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
458clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
459
da9356b0
RS
460+++
461*** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
462C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
463
406c0f12
RS
464+++
465*** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
466in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
467same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
468`help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
469keyboard oriented alternative.
470
471+++
472*** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
473automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
474point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
475determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
476to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
477
da9356b0
RS
478+++
479*** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
480When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
481be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
482available.
406c0f12
RS
483
484+++
da9356b0
RS
485*** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
486to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
487number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
488regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
489match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
490matching item.
491
da9356b0
RS
492** Incremental Search changes:
493
494+++
495*** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
496To enable this feature, customize the new user option
497`isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
498constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
499for details.
500
501+++
502*** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
503making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
504command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
505bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
506
507+++
508*** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
509at the end of a line.
510
511+++
512*** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
513Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
514and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
515
516+++
517*** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
518`query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
519search string used as the string to replace.
520
521+++
522*** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
523history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
524user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
525
526** Replace command changes:
406c0f12
RS
527
528---
da9356b0
RS
529*** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
530`query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
531a match if part of it has a read-only property.
406c0f12 532
da9356b0
RS
533+++
534*** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
535`replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
536where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
537time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
538`query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
539to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
540All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
541replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
542can be edited for each replacement.
406c0f12 543
da9356b0
RS
544+++
545*** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
546`query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
406c0f12 547
da9356b0
RS
548---
549*** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
550`query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
406c0f12 551
da9356b0
RS
552** File operation changes:
553
c44da964
RS
554+++
555*** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
556the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
557Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
558is only rarely needed.
559
da9356b0
RS
560+++
561*** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
562suffix are from every line before processing all the lines.
406c0f12 563
85df292e 564+++
406c0f12 565*** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
30b0da81 566when the file name contains wildcard characters.
d88beab5 567
85df292e 568+++
406c0f12 569*** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
30b0da81 570when the file name contains wildcard characters.
879054ea 571
94285c26 572+++
406c0f12 573*** Auto Compression mode is now enabled by default.
a27ddfaf 574
30b0da81 575---
406c0f12 576*** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
6695c528 577
30b0da81
RS
578Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
579of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
580directory with Dired.
6695c528 581
30b0da81 582+++
406c0f12 583*** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
30b0da81
RS
584read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
585want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
586file.)
a27ddfaf 587
70dce461 588+++
406c0f12 589*** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
30b0da81 590against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
70dce461 591
a775dff4 592+++
406c0f12 593*** The commands copy-file, rename-file, make-symbolic-link and
30b0da81
RS
594add-name-to-file, when given a directory as the "new name" argument,
595convert it to a file name by merging in the within-directory part of
596the existing file's name. (This is the same convention that shell
597commands cp, mv, and ln follow.) Thus, M-x copy-file RET ~/foo RET
598/tmp RET copies ~/foo to /tmp/foo.
f8f853de 599
a775dff4 600---
406c0f12 601*** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
4ba2fd66
LT
602before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
603supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
604
30b0da81 605---
406c0f12 606*** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
30b0da81
RS
607controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
608attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
9f14953b 609
406c0f12
RS
610+++
611*** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
da9356b0 612Emacs asks for confirmation.
406c0f12
RS
613
614+++
615*** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
616
617`visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
618when visiting the file.
619
620`visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
621needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
622when saving the file.
623
624+++
625*** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
626major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
627designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
628sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
629So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
630modes do.
631
406c0f12 632** Minibuffer changes:
428b6b85 633
a775dff4 634+++
406c0f12 635*** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
30b0da81
RS
636Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
637variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
638prompt string.
428b6b85 639
a775dff4 640---
c44da964 641*** Enhanced visual feedback in `*Completions*' buffer.
d3a29dd8 642
30b0da81
RS
643Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
644have in common and where they begin to differ.
e5c644da 645
30b0da81
RS
646The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
647`completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
648same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
649`completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
650`completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
651`completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
652parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
653parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
ecf4207f 654
30b0da81 655+++
da9356b0 656*** File-name completion can now ignore specified directories.
30b0da81
RS
657If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
658slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
659completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
660which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
661candidate is a directory.
ecf4207f 662
30b0da81 663+++
406c0f12 664*** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
30b0da81
RS
665to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
666it remains unchanged.
2a075e37 667
4d894c98 668+++
406c0f12 669*** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
30b0da81
RS
670If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
671elements are deleted.
2a075e37 672
da9356b0 673** Redisplay changes:
33b71f41 674
c44da964
RS
675+++
676*** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
677When the file is maintained under version control, that information
678appears between the position information and the major mode.
679
b854556f
DP
680*** Easy to overlook single character negation is now font-locked.
681You can use the new variable `font-lock-negation-char-face' and the face of
682the same name to customize this. Currently the cc-modes, sh-script-mode,
683cperl-mode and make-mode support this.
684
a775dff4 685+++
406c0f12 686*** Control characters and escape glyphs are now shown in the new
30b0da81 687escape-glyph face.
2a075e37 688
a775dff4 689+++
406c0f12 690*** Non-breaking space and hyphens are now prefixed with an escape
30b0da81
RS
691character, unless the new user variable `show-nonbreak-escape' is set
692to nil.
2a075e37 693
a775dff4 694+++
406c0f12
RS
695*** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
696The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
697the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
698will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
699
700The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
701hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
702window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
703window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
704many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
705gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
706
707The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
708`auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
fa2b23e5 709
406c0f12 710*** Moving or scrolling through images (and other lines) taller that
c44da964 711the window now works sensibly, by automatically adjusting the window's
30b0da81 712vscroll property.
2a075e37 713
406c0f12
RS
714+++
715*** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
716of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
717the mode line of the currently selected window.
ecf4207f 718
406c0f12
RS
719The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
720the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
721
722+++
723*** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
724for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
725top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
726control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
727set-fringe-style.
ee213e98 728
406c0f12 729+++
da9356b0
RS
730*** Angle icons in the fringes can indicate the buffer boundaries. In
731addition, up and down arrow bitmaps in the fringe indicate which ways
732the window can be scrolled.
2f9da07b 733
406c0f12
RS
734This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
735`indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
736this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
23f87bed 737
406c0f12
RS
738If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
739displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
23f87bed 740
da9356b0
RS
741The value can also be an alist which specifies the presense and
742position of each bitmap individually.
23f87bed 743
406c0f12
RS
744For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
745in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
746arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
747left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
61d244ca 748
a775dff4 749+++
406c0f12
RS
750*** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
751(not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
752two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
753Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
754cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
61d244ca 755
da9356b0 756The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' can be set to nil to
406c0f12 757revert to the old behavior of continuing such lines.
30b0da81 758
406c0f12 759+++
da9356b0 760*** When a window has display margin areas, the fringes are now
406c0f12 761displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
da9356b0 762outside those margins.
406c0f12
RS
763
764+++
da9356b0 765*** A window can now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
406c0f12
RS
766in addition to the individual display margin settings.
767
768Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
769horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
770or when the frame is resized.
771
da9356b0 772** Cursor display changes:
61d244ca 773
a775dff4 774+++
406c0f12 775*** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
30b0da81 776now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
200d028b 777
85df292e 778+++
406c0f12 779*** The X resource cursorBlink can be used to turn off cursor blinking.
61d244ca 780
30b0da81 781+++
406c0f12 782*** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
30b0da81
RS
783The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
784default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
785cursor does.
61d244ca 786
a775dff4 787+++
406c0f12 788*** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
30b0da81
RS
789of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
790appears in.
61d244ca 791
30b0da81 792+++
406c0f12 793*** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
30b0da81 794of the recognized cursor types.
61d244ca 795
da9356b0
RS
796** Font-Lock changes:
797
c44da964
RS
798+++
799*** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
800M-o M-o requests refontification.
801
30b0da81 802+++
da9356b0
RS
803*** All modes now support using M-x font-lock-mode to toggle
804fontification, even those such as Occur, Info, and comint-derived
805modes that do their own fontification in a special way.
806
807The variable `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable
808fontification in Info, remove `turn-on-font-lock' from
809`Info-mode-hook'.
810
811+++
812*** font-lock-lines-before specifies a number of lines before the
406c0f12
RS
813current line that should be refontified when you change the buffer.
814The default value is 1.
30b0da81 815
da9356b0
RS
816+++
817*** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
818an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
819font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
820if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
821trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
406c0f12 822
da9356b0 823---
406c0f12
RS
824*** The default settings for JIT stealth lock parameters are changed.
825The default value for the user option jit-lock-stealth-time is now 16
826instead of 3, and the default value of jit-lock-stealth-nice is now
8270.5 instead of 0.125. The new defaults should lower the CPU usage
828when Emacs is fontifying in the background.
829
da9356b0 830---
406c0f12
RS
831*** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
832
833If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
834idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
835example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
836only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
837
da9356b0 838---
406c0f12
RS
839*** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
840
841jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
842jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
843refontification takes place.
844
c44da964 845** Menu support:
406c0f12
RS
846
847---
848*** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
849This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
850as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
851You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
852it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
853current date and time, current line and column number in the
854mode-line.
855
856---
857*** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
858
c44da964
RS
859---
860*** You can exit dialog windows and menus by typing C-g.
861
862---
863*** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
864and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
865to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
866
867+++
868*** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
869disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
870
871---
872*** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
873be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
874
875+++
876*** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have
877to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example
878`-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'.
879
880---
881*** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
882ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
883
884+++
885*** For Gtk+ version 2.4, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
886by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
887the new dialog.
888
da9356b0 889** Mouse changes:
b1faee6e 890
85df292e 891+++
da9356b0 892*** New display feature: focus follows the mouse from one Emacs window
30b0da81
RS
893to another, even within a frame. If you set the variable
894mouse-autoselect-window to non-nil value, moving the mouse to a
895different Emacs window will select that window (minibuffer window can
896be selected only when it is active). The default is nil, so that this
897feature is not enabled.
61042632 898
30b0da81 899+++
da9356b0 900*** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
30b0da81
RS
901select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
902normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
903the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
904window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
905to give it focus.
61042632 906
ed2846bd 907+++
da9356b0 908*** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
30b0da81
RS
909
910Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
911click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
912click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
913inside a link. Now the behavior of a Mouse-1 click has been changed
ea0d5ebb
LT
914to match this context-sentitive dual behavior. (If you prefer the old
915behavior, set the user option `mouse-1-click-follows-link' to nil.)
30b0da81 916
da9356b0 917Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs can do much
30b0da81
RS
918more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behavior is only
919activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
920(see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The Lisp
921packages that are included in release 22.1 have been adapted to do
922this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
923is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
924happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behavior when you click
925on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
926
927If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
928just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
929click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
930you release it).
931
932Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
933drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
934
935You can customize the new Mouse-1 behavior via the new user options
936`mouse-1-click-follows-link' and `mouse-1-click-in-non-selected-windows'.
ee213e98 937
7e995a23 938+++
da9356b0 939*** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
30b0da81
RS
940is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
941can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
942mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
943also disable mouse highlighting.
a1bcf785
JL
944
945+++
da9356b0 946*** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
30b0da81
RS
947shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
948variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
949
950---
da9356b0 951*** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
30b0da81
RS
952(rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
953
954---
da9356b0 955*** Unexpected yanking of text due to accidental clicking on the mouse
30b0da81
RS
956wheel button (typically mouse-2) during wheel scrolling is now avoided.
957This behavior can be customized via the mouse-wheel-click-event and
958mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
ee213e98
JL
959
960+++
da9356b0 961*** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
ee213e98 962
da9356b0 963** Mule changes:
30b0da81
RS
964
965---
da9356b0 966*** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup
30b0da81
RS
967more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale
968name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines.
da9356b0 969This change can result in using the different coding systems as
30b0da81 970default in some locale (e.g. vi_VN).
61d244ca 971
85df292e 972+++
da9356b0 973*** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
30b0da81 974current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
da9356b0 975can mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
30b0da81
RS
976characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
977emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
978keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
979or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
980by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
8ab314f9
JL
981
982+++
da9356b0 983*** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
30b0da81 984revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
8ab314f9 985
30b0da81 986+++
da9356b0 987*** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
30b0da81 988coding system.
8ab314f9
JL
989
990+++
da9356b0 991*** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
30b0da81 992of a file.
8ab314f9
JL
993
994---
da9356b0 995*** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
30b0da81 996unicode.
8ab314f9 997
30b0da81 998+++
da9356b0 999*** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
30b0da81
RS
1000coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
1001(Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
1002command.
a1bcf785 1003
a775dff4 1004+++
da9356b0 1005*** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
30b0da81 1006in the current input method to input a character at point.
a1bcf785 1007
30b0da81 1008+++
da9356b0 1009*** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
30b0da81
RS
1010Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
1011the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
1012Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
1013sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
1014translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
1015mule-unicode-... ones.
a1bcf785 1016
30b0da81
RS
1017By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
1018Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
1019with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
1020possible.
a1bcf785 1021
30b0da81
RS
1022You can force a more complete unification with the user option
1023unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
1024into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
1025mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
1026will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
a1bcf785 1027
f60a6f87 1028---
da9356b0 1029*** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
30b0da81
RS
1030either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
1031when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
1032controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
d60f1316 1033
f60a6f87 1034---
da9356b0 1035*** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
30b0da81
RS
1036Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
1037Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
1038Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
1039automatically according to the locale.)
ee213e98
JL
1040
1041---
da9356b0 1042*** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
30b0da81
RS
1043ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
1044vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
1045latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
1046bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
1047tamil-inscript.
ee213e98 1048
a775dff4 1049---
da9356b0 1050*** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
30b0da81 1051characters.
a6aa9850 1052
30b0da81 1053---
da9356b0 1054*** Improved Thai support. A new minor mode `thai-word-mode' (which is
30b0da81
RS
1055automatically activated if you select Thai as a language
1056environment) changes key bindings of most word-oriented commands to
1057versions which recognize Thai words. Affected commands are
1058 M-f (forward-word)
1059 M-b (backward-word)
1060 M-d (kill-word)
1061 M-DEL (backward-kill-word)
1062 M-t (transpose-words)
1063 M-q (fill-paragraph)
a6aa9850 1064
30b0da81 1065---
da9356b0 1066*** Indian support has been updated.
30b0da81
RS
1067The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
1068assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
1069Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
1070supported.
a6aa9850 1071
30b0da81 1072---
da9356b0 1073*** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
a6aa9850 1074
30b0da81 1075---
da9356b0 1076*** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
30b0da81
RS
1077By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
1078single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
1079turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
1080sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
1081system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
1082interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
1083You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
1084`ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
1085coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
1086one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
1087The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
a6aa9850 1088
30b0da81 1089---
da9356b0 1090*** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
30b0da81
RS
1091in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
1092Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
bf078377 1093
30b0da81 1094---
da9356b0 1095*** Many new coding systems are available by loading the `code-pages'
30b0da81
RS
1096library. These include complete versions of most of those in
1097codepage.el, based on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now
1098obsolete and is used only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. windows-1252
1099and windows-1251 are preloaded since the former is so common and the
1100latter is used by GNU locales.
e0dc0c55 1101
30b0da81 1102---
da9356b0 1103*** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
30b0da81 1104Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
e0dc0c55 1105
30b0da81 1106---
da9356b0 1107*** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
30b0da81
RS
1108characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
1109fontset appropriately.
e0dc0c55 1110
da9356b0 1111** Customize changes:
fbe57420 1112
a775dff4 1113+++
da9356b0 1114*** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
30b0da81
RS
1115now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
1116specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
1117faces.
c64a682c 1118
85df292e 1119---
da9356b0 1120*** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
30b0da81
RS
1121In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1122check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1123for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1124sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1125its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1126case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
c64a682c 1127
a775dff4 1128+++
da9356b0 1129*** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
30b0da81
RS
1130the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1131You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1132under the "[State]" button.
c64a682c 1133
da9356b0
RS
1134** Buffer Menu changes:
1135
1136+++
1137*** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
1138buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to `T' in Buffer Menu
1139mode.
1140
1141+++
1142*** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1143with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1144whose names begin with space are omitted.
1145
1146---
1147*** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
1148`buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
1149in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
1150
1151`buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
1152leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
1153If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
1154shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
1155and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
1156
1157`buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
1158the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
1159t, and the status is shown.
1160
1161Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
1162the Buffers menu is regenerated.
1163
30b0da81 1164** Dired mode:
347003be 1165
a775dff4 1166---
30b0da81
RS
1167*** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
1168dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
1169introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
556621f6 1170
30b0da81
RS
1171+++
1172*** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
1173with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
1d1d1b1f 1174
30b0da81
RS
1175+++
1176*** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
1177of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
1d1d1b1f 1178
30b0da81
RS
1179+++
1180*** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
1181control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
1182by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
1183too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
1184doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
1185special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
8725c792 1186
30b0da81
RS
1187+++
1188*** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
1189into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
1d1d1b1f 1190
30b0da81 1191+++
da9356b0 1192*** In Dired-x, Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode.
61cb0b53 1193
da9356b0
RS
1194The mode toggling command is bound to M-o. A new command
1195dired-mark-omitted, bound to * O, marks omitted files. The variable
1196dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the mode toggling function
1197instead.
5ab0ceed 1198
30b0da81 1199+++
da9356b0
RS
1200*** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1201have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1202directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1203directory listing into a buffer.
0ec6b206 1204
da9356b0 1205** Comint changes:
ff6a3bfb 1206
f60a6f87 1207---
da9356b0 1208*** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
30b0da81
RS
1209option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
1210except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
1211controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
1212overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
2c37653c 1213
30b0da81
RS
1214The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
1215support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
957e7c38 1216
30b0da81
RS
1217`comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
1218read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
1219lines, including any prompts.
555c87d8 1220
30b0da81
RS
1221`comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
1222read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
1223part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
1224and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
1225not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
1226`kill-region' if read-only are involved: it copies the text to the
1227kill-ring, but does not delete it.
d7b590b1 1228
2b6bb1f2 1229+++
da9356b0 1230*** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
30b0da81
RS
1231modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1232like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1233otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
af7272b1 1234
da9356b0 1235*** `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields' has been renamed
30b0da81
RS
1236`comint-use-prompt-regexp'. The old name has been kept as an alias,
1237but declared obsolete.
cc305a60 1238
da9356b0 1239** M-x Compile changes:
8798ecdb 1240
dacec596 1241---
da9356b0 1242*** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
dacec596 1243
30b0da81
RS
1244Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
1245recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
1246red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
1247(controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
dacec596 1248
30b0da81
RS
1249Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
1250This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
1251This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
b03763f4 1252
30b0da81
RS
1253The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
1254you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
1255leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
1256`compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
1257that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
b03763f4 1258
30b0da81 1259The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
b03763f4 1260
2e4e635a 1261+++
30b0da81
RS
1262*** New user option `compilation-environment'.
1263This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
1264compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
1265subprocesses inherit.
4d3eda1c 1266
da9356b0
RS
1267+++
1268*** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
1269specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
1270in new face `next-error'.
1271
1272+++
1273*** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
1274compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
1275modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
1276buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
1277matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
1278C-c C-f.
1279
1280** Occur mode changes:
1281
1282+++
1283*** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1284C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1285switching to it.
1286
1287+++
1288*** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
1289the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
1290
1291+++
1292*** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1293search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1294`multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
1295buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
1296rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
1297
c44da964
RS
1298** Grep changes:
1299
30b0da81 1300+++
c44da964 1301*** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
175573ac 1302
da9356b0
RS
1303There's a new separate package grep.el, with its own submenu and
1304customization group.
fc2938d1 1305
813f3d41 1306---
da9356b0 1307*** M-x grep provides highlighting support.
fc2938d1 1308
30b0da81 1309Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
da9356b0 1310can be saved and automatically revisited.
fc2938d1 1311
30b0da81
RS
1312+++
1313*** `grep-find' is now also available under the name `find-grep' where
1314people knowing `find-grep-dired' would probably expect it.
a4ac5b17 1315
a775dff4 1316---
30b0da81 1317*** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
da9356b0
RS
1318`grep-scroll-output' override the corresponding compilation mode
1319settings, for grep commands only.
af3b9e47 1320
30b0da81
RS
1321+++
1322*** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlightes matches in *grep*
1323buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
1324--color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
1325match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
1326buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
1327source line is highlighted.
fc2938d1 1328
30b0da81
RS
1329+++
1330*** New key bindings in grep output window:
1331SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
1332previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
1333the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
1334other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
1335previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
1336file.
fc2938d1 1337
1c6576ab 1338+++
da9356b0 1339*** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
30b0da81
RS
1340by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1341detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1342When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1343unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1344command lines to be used than was possible before.
a4ac5b17 1345
406c0f12 1346** X Windows Support:
b5d2c621 1347
406c0f12
RS
1348+++
1349*** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
1350 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
1351 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
1a667242 1352
406c0f12
RS
1353+++
1354*** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
1355The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
1356and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
1357use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
1358Meta and Alt:
1359 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
1360 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
63a7fdcf 1361
406c0f12 1362+++
da9356b0 1363*** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which can
406c0f12 1364speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
813f3d41 1365
406c0f12
RS
1366If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
1367XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
a775dff4 1368
30b0da81 1369---
406c0f12
RS
1370*** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1371requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1372Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1373and use the more appropriately result.
a775dff4 1374
406c0f12
RS
1375---
1376*** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
1377On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
1378amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
a775dff4 1379
406c0f12
RS
1380** Xterm support:
1381
1382---
1383*** Emacs now responds to mouse-clicks on the mode-line, header-line and
1384display margin, when run in an xterm.
1385
1386---
1387*** Improved key bindings support when running in an xterm.
1388When emacs is running in an xterm more key bindings are available. The
fa2b23e5 1389following should work:
406c0f12
RS
1390{C,S,C-S,A}-{right,left,up,down,prior,next,delete,insert,F1-12}.
1391These key bindings work on xterm from X.org 6.8, they might not work on
1392some older versions of xterm, or on some proprietary versions.
1393
da9356b0 1394** Character terminal color support changes:
406c0f12
RS
1395
1396+++
1397*** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
1398mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1399terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1400database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1401set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1402terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1403when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1404in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1405user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1406
1407---
1408*** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1409than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1410256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1411the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1412all of these colors.
1413
1414+++
1415*** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1416faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1417256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
141888-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1419colors as on X.
1420
1421---
1422*** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
da9356b0 1423\f
c44da964 1424* New Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1
406c0f12 1425
da9356b0
RS
1426+++
1427** New package benchmark.el contains simple support for convenient
1428timing measurements of code (including the garbage collection component).
406c0f12
RS
1429
1430+++
1431** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
1432various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
1433program files that include other program files.
1434
1435Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
1436all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
1437in them.
1438
406c0f12
RS
1439+++
1440** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1441
1442Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
1443Emacs Lisp. Its documentation is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
1444type "C-h i m calc RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
1445available in `etc/calccard.tex' and `etc/calccard.ps'.
1446
1447---
1448** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
1449configuration files.
1450
1451+++
1452** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
1453varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
1454var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
1455section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
1456.config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
1457recognized.
1458
1459---
1460** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1461
1462The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
1463cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
1464With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
1465keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
1466region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
1467cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
1468
1469In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
1470rectangle highlighting: Use S-return to start a rectangle, extend it
1471using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
1472or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
1473
1474Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
1475fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
1476downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
1477rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
1478as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
1479M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
1480rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
1481
1482Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
1483prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
1484C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
1485
1486The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
1487register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
1488
1489Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
1490When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
1491automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
1492commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
1493
1494The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
1495kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
da9356b0 1496want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you can customize the
406c0f12
RS
1497`cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
1498
1499Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
1500versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
1501must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
1502loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
1503
1504+++
1505** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
1506The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
1507to increment the SOA serial.
1508
1509---
1510** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
1511filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
1512that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
1513emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
da9356b0 1514invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method can
406c0f12
RS
1515be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
1516
1517+++
1518** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
1519source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
1520
1521---
1522** The new Lisp library fringe.el controls the appearance of fringes.
1523
1524---
1525** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
1526
406c0f12
RS
1527---
1528** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
1529customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
1530
1531---
1532** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1533
1534The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
1535package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
1536to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
1537a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
1538
1539+++
1540** Image files are normally visited in Image mode, which lets you toggle
1541between viewing the image and viewing the text using C-c C-c.
1542
1543+++
1544** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
1545the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
1546keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
1547+, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
1548package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
1549
1550By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
1551`keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
1552using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
1553the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
1554possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
1555the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
1556
1557The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
1558`Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
1559`Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
1560decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
1561`Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
1562for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
1563where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
1564`Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
1565are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
1566or local keymaps.
1567
1568+++
1569** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
1570emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
1571
1572Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
1573F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
1574the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
1575which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
1576
1577There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
1578defined macros.
1579
1580The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
1581defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
1582C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
1583manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
1584C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
1585for more commands.
1586
1587The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
1588the keyboard macro ring.
1589
1590The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
1591before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
1592
1593In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
1594be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
1595this behavior via the variable kmacro-call-repeat-key and
1596kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
1597
1598Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
1599C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
1600at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
1601
1602+++
1603** The new package longlines.el provides a minor mode for editing text
1604files composed of long lines, based on the `use-hard-newlines'
1605mechanism. The long lines are broken up by inserting soft newlines,
1606which are automatically removed when saving the file to disk or
1607copying into the kill ring, clipboard, etc. By default, Longlines
1608mode inserts soft newlines automatically during editing, a behavior
1609referred to as "soft word wrap" in other text editors. This is
1610similar to Refill mode, but more reliable. To turn the word wrap
1611feature off, set `longlines-auto-wrap' to nil.
1612
406c0f12
RS
1613** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1614
1615If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
1616the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
1617with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
1618ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
1619printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
1620`ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
1621
1622+++
1623** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
1624
1625---
1626** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
1627move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
1628It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
1629of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
1630
1631There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
1632
1633---
1634** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
1635"active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
1636change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
1637settings.
1638
1639+++
1640** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
1641spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
1642letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
1643viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
1644
1645+++
1646** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
1647shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
1648
1649+++
1650** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
1651`text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
1652these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
1653table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
1654can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
1655as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
1656
1657+++
1658** The thumbs.el package allows you to preview image files as thumbnails
1659and can be invoked from a Dired buffer.
1660
1661+++
1662** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
1663
1664This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
1665files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
1666Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
1667for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
1668the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
1669`inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
1670connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
1671(which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
1672`rsync' to do the copying).
1673
1674Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
1675`su' and `sudo'. Ange-FTP is still supported via the `ftp' method.
1676
1677If you want to disable Tramp you should set
1678
1679 (setq tramp-default-method "ftp")
1680
1681---
1682** The library tree-widget.el provides a new widget to display a set
1683of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
1684well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
1685
1686---
1687** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
1688
1689---
1690** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
1691When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
1692restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
1693
1694+++
1695** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
1696buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
da9356b0
RS
1697
1698---
c44da964
RS
1699** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
1700This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
da9356b0 1701
c44da964
RS
1702** The new package bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
1703binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
1704data structures.
da9356b0
RS
1705
1706+++
c44da964
RS
1707** The new package button.el implements simple and fast `clickable buttons'
1708in emacs buffers. `buttons' are much lighter-weight than the `widgets'
1709implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that doesn't
1710require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for such things
1711as help and apropos buffers.
da9356b0
RS
1712
1713---
c44da964
RS
1714** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
1715buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
da9356b0 1716
c44da964
RS
1717It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
1718and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
1719buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
1720commands.
da9356b0 1721
c44da964
RS
1722This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
1723sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
1724SQL buffer.
1725
1726(add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
1727 (function (lambda ()
1728 (master-mode t)
1729 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
1730(add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
1731 (function (lambda ()
1732 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
da9356b0
RS
1733
1734+++
c44da964
RS
1735** New Lisp library testcover.el works with edebug to help you determine
1736whether you've tested all your Lisp code. Function testcover-start
1737instruments all functions in a given file. Then test your code. Function
1738testcover-mark-all adds overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to
1739show where coverage is lacking. Command testcover-next-mark (bind it to
1740a key!) will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
1741
1742Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely
1743evaluated; a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same
1744value. The red splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly
1745complete their evaluation, such as `error'. The brown splotches are
1746skipped for forms that are expected to always evaluate to the same
1747value, such as (setq x 14).
1748
1749For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to
1750help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a
1751red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does
1752return. The macro 1value suppresses a brown splotch for its argument.
1753This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals
1754an error if the argument actually returns differing values.
1755\f
1756* Changes in Specialized Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1:
da9356b0 1757
dda6a168
DP
1758** Makefile mode has now been split up into specialized modes for automake,
1759gmake, makepp and BSD make. The former two couldn't be differentiated before,
1760and the latter two are new. Font-locking is robust now and offers new
1761customizable faces.
1762
406c0f12 1763+++
c44da964
RS
1764** In Outline mode, hide-body no longer hides lines at the top
1765of the file that precede the first header line.
406c0f12
RS
1766
1767+++
c44da964
RS
1768** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
1769
1770---
1771** The terminal emulation code in term.el has been improved, it can
1772run most curses applications now.
1773
1774+++
1775** M-x diff uses diff-mode instead of compilation-mode.
1776
1777+++
1778** You can now customize fill-nobreak-predicate to control where
1779filling can break lines. The value is now normally a list of
1780functions, but it can also be a single function, for compatibility.
1781
1782We provide two sample predicates, fill-single-word-nobreak-p and
1783fill-french-nobreak-p, for use in the value of fill-nobreak-predicate.
1784
1785---
1786** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
1787with special modes such as Tar mode.
1788
1789---
1790** Commands winner-redo and winner-undo, from winner.el, are now bound to
1791C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an incompatible change.
1792
1793---
1794** global-whitespace-mode is a new alias for whitespace-global-mode.
1795
1796+++
1797** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
1798resync points in both windows.
1799
1800+++
1801** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
1802When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
1803starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
406c0f12
RS
1804
1805---
1806** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
1807when Emacs visits them.
1808
c44da964 1809** Info mode changes:
406c0f12
RS
1810
1811+++
1812*** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
1813with the number appended to the *info* buffer name (e.g. "*info*<2>").
1814
1815---
1816*** isearch in Info uses Info-search and searches through multiple nodes.
1817Before leaving the initial Info node isearch fails once with the error
1818message [initial node], and with subsequent C-s/C-r continues through
1819other nodes. When isearch fails for the rest of the manual, it wraps
1820aroung the whole manual to the top/final node. The user option
1821`Info-isearch-search' controls whether to use Info-search for isearch,
1822or the default isearch search function that wraps around the current
1823Info node.
1824
1825*** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
1826`Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
1827search without prompting for a new search string.
1828
1829*** New command `Info-history-forward' (bound to r and new toolbar icon)
1830moves forward in history to the node you returned from after using
1831`Info-history-back' (renamed from `Info-last').
1832
1833*** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
1834
1835*** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
1836from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
1837
1838*** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
1839Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
1840possible matches.
1841
1842*** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
1843the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
1844arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
1845
1846---
1847*** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
1848and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
1849
1850*** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
1851references and following them calls `browse-url'.
1852
1853+++
1854*** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
1855If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
1856`Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
1857
1858---
1859*** Images in Info pages are supported.
1860Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
1861Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
1862version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
1863
1864+++
1865*** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
c64a682c 1866
30b0da81
RS
1867---
1868*** Info-index offers completion.
3996d07a 1869
406c0f12
RS
1870** Lisp mode changes:
1871
30b0da81 1872---
406c0f12 1873*** Lisp mode now uses font-lock-doc-face for the docstrings.
62ce3608 1874
1c6576ab 1875+++
406c0f12 1876*** A prefix argument of C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-printifies the
30b0da81 1877list starting after point.
c145bbb3 1878
406c0f12 1879*** New features in evaluation commands
81f755ae 1880
85df292e 1881+++
30b0da81
RS
1882*** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
1883the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
1791907b 1884
a775dff4 1885+++
30b0da81
RS
1886*** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
1887in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
1888by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
1889function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
1890`eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
1791907b 1891
a775dff4 1892+++
c44da964 1893** CC mode changes.
a31a30b5 1894
30b0da81
RS
1895*** Font lock support.
1896CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
1897supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
1898package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
1899locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
1900AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
1901different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
836c086b 1902
30b0da81
RS
1903The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
1904dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
1905strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
1906declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
1907lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
1908the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
1909demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
1910therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
1911variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
90e87070 1912
30b0da81
RS
1913Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
1914fontification in mind, i.e. there should be a support mode that waits
1915with the fontification until the text is actually shown
1916(e.g. Just-in-time Lock mode, which is the default, or Lazy Lock
1917mode). Fontifying a file with several thousand lines in one go can
1918take the better part of a minute.
26fb226b 1919
30b0da81
RS
1920**** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
1921are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
1922be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
1923locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
1924properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
1925not contain patterns for uncertain types.
fd42af9d 1926
30b0da81
RS
1927**** Support for documentation comments.
1928There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
1929Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
1930language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
1931buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
236f1c76 1932
30b0da81
RS
1933Currently two kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Suns Javadoc
1934and Autodoc which is used in Pike. This is by no means a complete
1935list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor of choice
1936is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
fd4f8b36 1937
30b0da81
RS
1938**** Better handling of C++ templates.
1939As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
1940now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
1941given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
1942parens.
89f8199f 1943
30b0da81
RS
1944This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
1945work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
1946template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
1947recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
1948not as configurable as it ought to be.
1f600b1b 1949
30b0da81
RS
1950**** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
1951Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
1952The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
1953All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
1954handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
a9c6d330 1955
30b0da81
RS
1956*** Support for the AWK language.
1957Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
1958based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
1959any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
1960Here is a summary:
2d4ef682 1961
30b0da81
RS
1962**** Indentation Engine
1963The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
a4fc6fc9 1964
30b0da81
RS
1965AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
1966which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
1967placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
1968are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
1969definition, or structured statement.
5e101746 1970
30b0da81
RS
1971The predefined indentation functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
1972mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't be
1973any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
5e101746 1974
30b0da81
RS
1975The command C-c C-q (c-indent-defun) hasn't yet been adapted for AWK,
1976though in practice it works properly nearly all the time. Should it
1977fail, explicitly set the region around the function (using C-u C-SPC:
1978C-M-h probably won't work either) then do C-M-\ (indent-region).
b54cfb55 1979
30b0da81
RS
1980**** Font Locking
1981There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
1982three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
1983idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
1984the AWK language itself.
7cc8f35a 1985
30b0da81
RS
1986**** Comment Commands
1987M-; (indent-for-comment) works fine. None of the other CC Mode
1988comment formatting commands have yet been adapted for AWK mode.
e0c124ce 1989
30b0da81
RS
1990**** Movement Commands
1991Most of the movement commands work in AWK mode. The most important
1992exceptions are M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) and M-e
1993(c-end-of-statement) which haven't yet been adapted.
7cc8f35a 1994
30b0da81
RS
1995The notion of "defun" has been augmented to include AWK pattern-action
1996pairs. C-M-a (c-awk-beginning-of-defun) and C-M-e (c-awk-end-of-defun)
1997recognise these pattern-action pairs, as well as user defined
1998functions.
11a365f9 1999
30b0da81
RS
2000**** Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
2001Auto-newline insertion hasn't yet been adapted for AWK. Some of
2002the clean-ups can actually convert good AWK code into syntactically
2003invalid code. These features are best disabled in AWK buffers.
7cc8f35a 2004
30b0da81
RS
2005*** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
2006The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
2007now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
2008module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
2009composition-close, and incomposition.
6625fc7d 2010
30b0da81
RS
2011*** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
2012The functions c-hungry-backspace and c-hungry-delete-forward can be
2013bound to keys to get this feature without toggling a mode.
2014Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
6625fc7d 2015
30b0da81
RS
2016*** Better control over require-final-newline. The variable that
2017controls how to handle a final newline when the buffer is saved,
2018require-final-newline, is now customizable on a per-mode basis through
2019c-require-final-newline. That is a list of modes, and only those
2020modes set require-final-newline. By default that's C, C++ and
2021Objective-C.
cb8d4d07 2022
30b0da81
RS
2023The specified modes set require-final-newline based on
2024mode-require-final-newline, as usual.
4e3dd7cf 2025
30b0da81
RS
2026*** Format change for syntactic context elements.
2027The elements in the syntactic context returned by c-guess-basic-syntax
2028and stored in c-syntactic-context has been changed somewhat to allow
2029attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
2030cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
00b1ee61 2031
30b0da81 2032((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
00b1ee61 2033
30b0da81 2034is now analysed as
00b1ee61 2035
30b0da81 2036((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
00b1ee61 2037
30b0da81
RS
2038In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
2039symbol.
00b1ee61 2040
30b0da81
RS
2041This change might affect code that call c-guess-basic-syntax directly,
2042and custom lineup functions if they use c-syntactic-context. However,
2043the argument given to lineup functions is still a single cons cell
2044with nil or an integer in the cdr.
93607efd 2045
30b0da81
RS
2046*** API changes for derived modes.
2047There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
2048derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
2049incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
2050care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
2051Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
93607efd 2052
30b0da81
RS
2053**** New language variable system.
2054See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
93607efd 2055
30b0da81
RS
2056**** New initialization functions.
2057The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
2058give better control: c-basic-common-init, c-font-lock-init, and
2059c-init-language-vars.
93607efd 2060
30b0da81
RS
2061*** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
2062The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
2063several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
2064now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
93607efd 2065
30b0da81
RS
2066This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
2067although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
2068gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
2069where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
2070it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
93607efd 2071
30b0da81
RS
2072**** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
2073This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
2074its substatement. E.g:
2075
2076 if (x)
2077 x_is_true:
2078 do_stuff();
2079
2080*** Better handling of multiline macros.
2081
2082**** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
2083The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
2084syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
2085variable c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros. A new syntactic symbol
2086cpp-define-intro has been added to control the initial indentation
2087inside #define's.
2088
2089**** New lineup function c-lineup-cpp-define.
2090Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
2091of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
2092is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
2093removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
2094much line c-lineup-dont-change, which was used earlier, but handles
2095empty lines within the macro better.
2096
2097**** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
2098This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
2099c-context-line-break and c-context-open-line.
2100
2101**** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2102c-backslash-region tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
2103variable c-backslash-max-column which put a limit on how far out
2104backslashes can be moved.
2105
2106**** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2107This is controlled by the new variable c-auto-align-backslashes. It
2108affects c-context-line-break, c-context-open-line and newlines
2109inserted in auto-newline mode.
2110
2111**** Line indentation works better inside macros.
2112Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
2113inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
2114line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
2115indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
2116backslash) in the macro.
2117
2118*** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
2119The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
2120the variable c-indent-comment-alist. The indentation behavior based
2121on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after #else
2122and #endif but indentation to comment-column in most other cases
2123(something which was hardcoded earlier).
2124
2125*** New function c-context-open-line.
2126It's the open-line equivalent of c-context-line-break.
2127
2128*** New lineup functions
2129
2130**** c-lineup-string-cont
2131This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
2132continues. E.g:
2133
2134result = prefix + "A message "
2135 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
2136
2137**** c-lineup-cascaded-calls
2138Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
2139
2140**** c-lineup-knr-region-comment
2141Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
2142the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
2143
2144**** c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg
2145Provides better indentation inside asm blocks. Contributed by Kevin
2146Ryde.
2147
2148**** c-lineup-argcont
2149Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
2150Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
2151
2152*** Better caching of the syntactic context.
2153CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
2154of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
2155places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
2156improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
2157moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
2158
2159The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
2160opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
2161only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
2162file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
2163context.
2164
2165*** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
2166Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
2167"invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
2168happen when macros are involved.
2169
2170*** Improved the way c-indent-exp chooses the block to indent.
2171It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
2172whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
2173point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
2174Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
2175line is left untouched.
2176
2177*** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
2178The function c-toggle-syntactic-indentation can be used to toggle
2179syntactic indentation.
2180
2181---
2182** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
2183
da9356b0
RS
2184---
2185** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2186to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2187bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2188C-c C-i b, and so on.
2189
406c0f12
RS
2190** Fortran mode changes:
2191
30b0da81 2192---
406c0f12 2193*** Fortran mode does more font-locking by default. Use level 3
30b0da81 2194highlighting for the old default.
93607efd 2195
e42d6474 2196+++
406c0f12 2197*** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
30b0da81
RS
2198Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
2199Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
e42d6474 2200
2b6bb1f2 2201+++
406c0f12 2202*** F90 mode and Fortran mode have new navigation commands
30b0da81
RS
2203`f90-end-of-block', `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block',
2204`f90-previous-block', `fortran-end-of-block',
2205`fortran-beginning-of-block'.
2206
2207---
406c0f12 2208*** F90 mode and Fortran mode have support for hs-minor-mode (hideshow).
30b0da81
RS
2209It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
2210majority.
2211
2212---
406c0f12 2213*** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
30b0da81
RS
2214the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
2215
2216---
2217** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2218to support use of font-lock.
2219
406c0f12
RS
2220** HTML/SGML changes:
2221
30b0da81 2222---
406c0f12 2223*** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
30b0da81 2224automatically.
a207b33c 2225
e42d6474 2226+++
406c0f12 2227*** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
30b0da81
RS
2228The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
2229When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
2230i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2231By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
2232from the file name or buffer contents.
2233
2234+++
406c0f12 2235*** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
30b0da81
RS
2236
2237** TeX modes:
2238
2239+++
2240*** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
2241
2242+++
2243*** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
2244by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
2245command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
2246TeX commands to use at startup.
2247
2248---
2249*** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
2250and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
2251
2252+++
2253*** New major mode doctex-mode for *.dtx files.
2254
2255** BibTeX mode:
2256*** The new command bibtex-url browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
2257point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
2258
2259*** The new command bibtex-entry-update (bound to C-c C-u) updates
2260an existing BibTeX entry.
2261
2262*** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
2263
2264*** bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries can take values `plain',
2265`crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
2266for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
2267scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
2268automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
2269bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries is non-nil.
e42d6474 2270
30b0da81
RS
2271*** If the new variable bibtex-parse-keys-fast is non-nil,
2272use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
59035302 2273
30b0da81
RS
2274*** If the new variable bibtex-autoadd-commas is non-nil,
2275automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
59035302 2276
30b0da81
RS
2277*** The new variable bibtex-autofill-types contains a list of entry
2278types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
2a075e37 2279
30b0da81
RS
2280*** The new command bibtex-complete completes word fragment before
2281point according to context (bound to M-tab).
2a075e37 2282
30b0da81
RS
2283*** The new commands bibtex-find-entry and bibtex-find-crossref
2284locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
2285Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
d9f7eb77 2286
30b0da81
RS
2287*** In BibTeX mode the command fill-paragraph (bound to M-q) fills
2288individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
b54cfb55 2289
30b0da81
RS
2290*** The new variables bibtex-files and bibtex-file-path define a set
2291of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
4e3dd7cf 2292
30b0da81
RS
2293*** The new command bibtex-validate-globally checks for duplicate keys
2294in multiple BibTeX files.
4e3dd7cf 2295
30b0da81
RS
2296*** The new command bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill pushes summary
2297of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
c721078e 2298
30b0da81
RS
2299+++
2300** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
2301by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
2302and `C-c C-r'.
63db1bb3 2303
406c0f12
RS
2304** GUD changes:
2305
2b6bb1f2 2306+++
406c0f12 2307*** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
4febb0e7
RS
2308counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
2309
30b0da81 2310---
406c0f12 2311*** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
30b0da81
RS
2312and other common debugger commands.
2313
da9356b0
RS
2314+++
2315*** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
2316GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
2317there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
2318state of your program. It separates the input/output of your program from
2319that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
2320Emacs 21 such as the display margin for breakpoints, and the toolbar.
2321
2322Use M-x gdba to start GDB-UI.
2323
2324*** GUD tooltips can be toggled independently of normal tooltips
2325with the minor mode, gud-tooltip-mode.
2326
2327+++
2328*** In graphical mode, with a C program, GUD Tooltips have been extended to
2329display the #define directive associated with an identifier when program is
2330not executing.
2331
2b6bb1f2 2332---
ca64d378 2333** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
a1e3dda0
RS
2334
2335*** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
2336 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
2337 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
2338 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2339 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
2340
2341*** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
2342 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
2343 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
2344 (gud-finish).
2345
2346*** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
2347 (Java 1.1 jdb).
2348
2349*** The previous method of searching for source files has been
2350 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
2351 Set gud-jdb-use-classpath to nil.
2352
2353 Added Customization Variables
2354
2355*** gud-jdb-command-name. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
2356
2357*** gud-jdb-use-classpath. Allows selection of java source file searching
2358 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan gud-jdb-directories for
2359 java sources (previous method).
2360
2361*** gud-jdb-directories. List of directories to scan and search for java
2362 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if gud-jdb-use-classpath
2363 is nil).
2364
2365 Minor Improvements
2366
9e94e254
SJ
2367*** The STARTTLS elisp wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
2368instead of the OpenSSL based "starttls" tool. For backwards
d1b2b8cc 2369compatibility, it prefers "starttls", but you can toggle
9e94e254
SJ
2370`starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
2371"starttls" tool).
2372
a1e3dda0
RS
2373*** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
2374
406c0f12
RS
2375** Auto-Revert changes:
2376
1c6576ab 2377+++
406c0f12 2378*** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
30b0da81
RS
2379If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
2380mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
2381displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
2382the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
2383just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
da9356b0 2384rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior can
30b0da81 2385be mode dependent.
16927a56 2386
30b0da81
RS
2387If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
2388then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
2389mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
2390toggles this mode.
3aa2f38a 2391
1c6576ab 2392+++
406c0f12 2393*** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
30b0da81
RS
2394other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
2395revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
2396and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
2397mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
2398`revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
2399decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
2400that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
2401work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
6c0b2643 2402
a775dff4 2403+++
406c0f12 2404*** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
30b0da81
RS
2405Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
2406control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
2407which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
2408only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
c60ee5e7 2409
1c6576ab 2410---
30b0da81 2411** recentf changes.
33d0b73f 2412
30b0da81
RS
2413The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
2414enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
2415automatic cleanup.
554b59cd 2416
30b0da81
RS
2417The `recentf-keep' option replaces `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p'
2418and provides a more general mechanism to customize which file names to
2419keep in the recent list.
f43ae016 2420
30b0da81
RS
2421With the more advanced option: `recentf-filename-handler', you can
2422specify a function that transforms filenames handled by recentf. For
2423example, if set to `file-truename', the same file will not be in the
2424recent list with different symbolic links.
97f3be50 2425
30b0da81
RS
2426To follow naming convention, `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag'
2427replaces the misnamed option `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The
2428old name remains available as alias, but has been marked obsolete.
b9e6b498 2429
0fbe422d 2430+++
30b0da81 2431** Desktop package
0fbe422d 2432
a775dff4 2433+++
30b0da81
RS
2434*** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, desktop-save-mode. Variable
2435desktop-enable is obsolete. Customize desktop-save-mode to enable desktop
2436saving.
d71d20ea 2437
30b0da81
RS
2438---
2439*** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
2440buffer list.
3f270c8a 2441
85df292e 2442+++
30b0da81
RS
2443*** The desktop package can be customized to restore only some buffers immediately,
2444remaining buffers are restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
fc08c987 2445
30b0da81
RS
2446+++
2447*** New commands:
2448 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
2449 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
2450 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
2451 it was loaded.
2452 - desktop-lazy-complete runs the desktop load to completion.
2453 - desktop-lazy-abort aborts lazy loading of the desktop.
fc08c987 2454
30b0da81
RS
2455---
2456*** New customizable variables:
2457 - desktop-save. Determins whether the desktop should be saved when it is
2458 killed.
2459 - desktop-file-name-format. Format in which desktop file names should be saved.
2460 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
2461 - desktop-locals-to-save. List of local variables to save.
2462 - desktop-globals-to-clear. List of global variables that `desktop-clear' will clear.
2463 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp. Regexp identifying buffers that `desktop-clear'
2464 should not delete.
2465 - desktop-restore-eager. Number of buffers to restore immediately. Remaining buffers are
2466 restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
2467 - desktop-lazy-verbose. Verbose reporting of lazily created buffers.
2468 - desktop-lazy-idle-delay. Idle delay before starting to create buffers.
fc08c987 2469
1c6576ab 2470+++
30b0da81 2471*** New command line option --no-desktop
3f270c8a 2472
30b0da81
RS
2473---
2474*** New hooks:
2475 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
2476 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
2477
2478---
2479** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
2480When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
2481include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
2482Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
2483to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
2484and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
2485feature.
c64a682c 2486
eb766f96
MK
2487** EDiff changes.
2488
16757dcf 2489+++
eb766f96
MK
2490*** When comparing directories.
2491Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
2492directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
2493from one directory to another.
2494
16757dcf 2495+++
eb766f96
MK
2496*** When comparing files or buffers.
2497Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
2498currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
2499then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
2500comparison.
2501
5d9c22fd 2502*** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
813f3d41
RS
2503backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
2504`ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
2505
ca8f3642 2506+++
e94a3679
FP
2507** Etags changes.
2508
73639417
FP
2509*** New regular expressions features
2510
2511**** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
df3eebcb
FP
2512The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
2513only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
2514--regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
2515where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
2516more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
6861f0e3
FP
2517(single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
2518expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
2519(which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
2520span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
2521and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
2522
2c37653c 2523**** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in Gcc.
6861f0e3
FP
2524The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
2525respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
2526CR, TAB, VT,
2527
2c37653c 2528**** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
df3eebcb
FP
2529The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
2530only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
2531particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
2532
2c37653c 2533**** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
df3eebcb
FP
2534The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
2535per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
2536
73639417
FP
2537*** New language parsing features
2538
d9256ccb
FP
2539**** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
2540Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
2541
5dc59f2e
FP
2542**** The gnucc __attribute__ keyword is now recognised and ignored.
2543
dfcb9727
FP
2544**** New language HTML.
2545Title and h1, h2, h3 are tagged. Also, tags are generated when name= is
2546used inside an anchor and whenever id= is used.
2547
2548**** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
2549If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
2550size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
2551
5dc59f2e
FP
2552**** New language Lua.
2553All functions are tagged.
dfcb9727 2554
73639417 2555**** In Perl, packages are tags.
81d66c62
FP
2556Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
2557as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
2558package::sub.
2559
dfcb9727
FP
2560**** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
2561
2c37653c
FP
2562**** New language PHP.
2563Tags are functions, classes and defines.
5dc59f2e 2564If the --members option is specified to etags, tags are variables also.
f175bfff 2565
73639417 2566**** New default keywords for TeX.
a0bbc0c5
FP
2567The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
2568renewenvironment.
2569
81d66c62
FP
2570*** Honour #line directives.
2571When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
2572directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
2573specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
2574created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
2575writes tags pointing to the source file.
bf8dd4e3 2576
2c37653c 2577*** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
a0bbc0c5 2578This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
5cc4f104 2579be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
dfcb9727 2580reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
a0bbc0c5 2581the file FILE.
06ee6fcd 2582
30b0da81 2583** VC Changes
b5a67081 2584
30b0da81
RS
2585+++
2586*** The key C-x C-q no longer checks files in or out, it only changes
2587the read-only state of the buffer (toggle-read-only). We made this
2588change because we held a poll and found that many users were unhappy
2589with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this behavior, you
2590can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your .emacs:
b5a67081 2591
30b0da81 2592 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
b5a67081 2593
30b0da81 2594The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
b5a67081 2595
30b0da81
RS
2596+++
2597*** There is a new user option `vc-cvs-global-switches' that allows
2598you to specify switches that are passed to any CVS command invoked
2599by VC. These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which
2600means they are inserted before the command name. For example, this
2601allows you to specify a compression level using the "-z#" option for
2602CVS.
b5a67081 2603
30b0da81
RS
2604+++
2605*** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
b5a67081 2606
30b0da81 2607+++
406c0f12 2608*** vc-annotate-mode enhancements
b5a67081 2609
30b0da81
RS
2610In vc-annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2611enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2612to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
b5a67081 2613
30b0da81
RS
2614 P: annotates the previous revision
2615 N: annotates the next revision
2616 J: annotates the revision at line
2617 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2618 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2619 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2620 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
b5a67081 2621
406c0f12
RS
2622** pcl-cvs changes:
2623
30b0da81 2624+++
406c0f12 2625*** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
30b0da81
RS
2626between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2627in the repository.
b5a67081 2628
30b0da81 2629+++
406c0f12 2630*** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
30b0da81
RS
2631anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2632"checkout", "update" or "commit". That means using cvs diff options
2633-rBASE -rHEAD.
b5a67081 2634
c44da964
RS
2635+++
2636** There is a new user option `mail-default-directory' that allows you
2637to specify the value of `default-directory' for mail buffers. This
2638directory is used for auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to
2639"~/".
2640
2641+++
2642** Emacs can now indicate in the mode-line the presence of new e-mail
2643in a directory or in a file. See the documentation of the user option
2644`display-time-mail-directory'.
2645
da9356b0
RS
2646** Rmail changes:
2647
2648---
2649*** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
2650
2651+++
2652*** Support for `movemail' from GNU mailutils was added to Rmail.
2653This version of `movemail' allows to read mail from a wide range of
2654mailbox formats, including remote POP3 and IMAP4 mailboxes with or
2655without TLS encryption. If GNU mailutils is installed on the system
2656and its version of `movemail' can be found in exec-path, it will be
2657used instead of the native one.
2658
30b0da81 2659** Gnus package
b5a67081 2660
30b0da81
RS
2661---
2662*** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
2663Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
2664PGP/MIME.
b5a67081 2665
30b0da81
RS
2666---
2667*** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
2668See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
b5a67081 2669
30b0da81
RS
2670---
2671** MH-E changes.
b5a67081 2672
30b0da81
RS
2673Upgraded to MH-E version 7.82. There have been major changes since
2674version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
b5a67081 2675
406c0f12
RS
2676** Calendar changes:
2677
30b0da81 2678+++
406c0f12 2679*** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
30b0da81 2680convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
b5a67081 2681
30b0da81 2682+++
406c0f12 2683*** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
30b0da81
RS
2684Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
2685`diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
2686which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
2687how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
2688single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
2689day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
2690face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
2691appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
b5a67081 2692
30b0da81 2693+++
406c0f12 2694*** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
30b0da81
RS
2695year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
2696count backward from the end of the year.
b5a67081 2697
30b0da81 2698+++
406c0f12 2699*** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
30b0da81
RS
2700prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
2701day of that ISO week.
b5a67081 2702
30b0da81 2703---
406c0f12 2704*** The new variable `calendar-minimum-window-height' affects the
30b0da81 2705window generated by the function `generate-calendar-window'.
b5a67081 2706
30b0da81 2707---
406c0f12 2708*** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
30b0da81
RS
2709optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
2710rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
2711`christian-holidays' simpler.
b5a67081 2712
30b0da81 2713---
406c0f12 2714*** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
30b0da81
RS
2715This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
2716and `diary-header-line-format'.
b5a67081 2717
406c0f12
RS
2718+++
2719*** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed: use
2720the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
2721`appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
2722appt-issue-message, appt-visible, and appt-msg-window.
2723
2724+++
2725*** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
2726and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
2727from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
2728`diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
2729formats.
ffe5000a 2730
2b6bb1f2 2731---
30b0da81 2732** sql changes.
2461722b 2733
30b0da81
RS
2734*** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
2735SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
2736buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
2737session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
2738SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
2461722b 2739
30b0da81 2740The following values are supported:
2461722b 2741
30b0da81
RS
2742 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
2743 db2 DB2
2744 informix Informix
2745 ingres Ingres
2746 interbase Interbase
2747 linter Linter
2748 ms Microsoft
2749 mysql MySQL
2750 oracle Oracle
2751 postgres Postgres
2752 solid Solid
2753 sqlite SQLite
2754 sybase Sybase
2461722b 2755
30b0da81
RS
2756The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
2757SQL mode indicator.
2461722b 2758
30b0da81
RS
2759The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
2760your .emacs will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
2761`sql-product' to accomplish this.
cd3782b4 2762
30b0da81 2763ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
7920598e 2764
30b0da81
RS
2765*** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
2766font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
2767all identifiers ending in "_t" under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
2768you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
7920598e 2769
30b0da81
RS
2770 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
2771 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
2461722b 2772
30b0da81
RS
2773*** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i. Most
2774SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
2775highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
ffe5000a 2776
30b0da81
RS
2777*** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
2778Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
2779sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
2780osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
2781are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
2782terminated.
ffe5000a 2783
30b0da81
RS
2784If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
2785called with the -E command line argument to use the operating system
2786credentials to authenticate the user.
cc801373 2787
30b0da81
RS
2788*** Postgres support is enhanced.
2789Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
2790the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
cc801373 2791
30b0da81
RS
2792*** MySQL support is enhanced.
2793Keyword higlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
ffe5000a 2794
30b0da81
RS
2795*** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
2796packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
2797defaults.
e1fa392b 2798
30b0da81
RS
2799*** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
2800appropriate sql-interactive-mode wrapper for the current setting of
2801`sql-product'.
e1fa392b 2802
30b0da81 2803---
406c0f12
RS
2804*** Support for the SQLite interpreter has been added to sql.el by calling
2805'sql-sqlite'.
9d00469f 2806
406c0f12 2807** FFAP changes:
dedbac89 2808
30b0da81 2809+++
406c0f12
RS
2810*** New ffap commands and keybindings: C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
2811C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
2812C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
2813C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
dedbac89 2814
406c0f12
RS
2815---
2816*** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default. C-x C-f passes
2817it to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS argument, which visits
2818multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
ee31cd78 2819
406c0f12
RS
2820---
2821** skeleton.el now supports using - to mark the skeleton-point without
2822 interregion interaction. @ has reverted to only setting
2823 skeleton-positions and no longer sets skeleton-point. Skeletons
2824 which used @ to mark skeleton-point independent of _ should now use -
2825 instead. The updated skeleton-insert docstring explains these new
2826 features along with other details of skeleton construction.
ee31cd78 2827
406c0f12
RS
2828---
2829** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
2830used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
2831handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
2832temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
30b0da81 2833
406c0f12
RS
2834+++
2835** hide-ifdef-mode now uses overlays rather than selective-display
2836to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
2837changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
c8636435 2838
406c0f12
RS
2839---
2840** partial-completion-mode now does partial completion on directory names.
d0ee2ed3 2841
406c0f12
RS
2842---
2843** The type-break package now allows `type-break-file-name' to be nil
2844and if so, doesn't store any data across sessions. This is handy if
2845you don't want the .type-break file in your home directory or are
2846annoyed by the need for interaction when you kill Emacs.
7320911b 2847
406c0f12
RS
2848---
2849** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
a020987f 2850
406c0f12
RS
2851Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
2852ps-print, provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF fonts.
2853See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
c90e7e43 2854
406c0f12
RS
2855---
2856** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
2857This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
2858the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
2859using strokes as an input method.
0f7a93c1 2860
c44da964
RS
2861** Emacs server changes:
2862
2863+++
2864*** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
2865
2866 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
2867 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
2868 % emacsclient -s foo file1
2869 % emacsclient -s bar file2
2870
2871+++
2872*** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
2873`--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given elisp
2874expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
2875
2876+++
2877*** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
2878
406c0f12
RS
2879---
2880** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
cbbfedb2 2881
85df292e 2882+++
406c0f12
RS
2883** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
2884M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
2885argument it toggles the mode.
2886
2887Turning off PC-Selection mode restores the global key bindings
2888that were replaced by turning on the mode.
376de739 2889
30b0da81 2890---
406c0f12
RS
2891** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
2892`file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
092de21d 2893
406c0f12
RS
2894---
2895** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
2896Emacs will still work on terminals that require magic cookies in order
2897to use standout mode, however they will not be able to display
2898mode-lines in inverse-video.
092de21d 2899
406c0f12
RS
2900---
2901** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
092de21d 2902
406c0f12
RS
2903`mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
2904default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
2905automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
2e2d7ee6 2906
30b0da81 2907---
406c0f12 2908** display-battery has been replaced by display-battery-mode.
08fd1251 2909
406c0f12
RS
2910---
2911** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode, which is available when
2912`calculator-output-radix' is non-nil. In this mode a separator
2913character is used every few digits, making it easier to see byte
2914boundries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the variable
2915`calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
5b3dedcc 2916
30b0da81 2917---
406c0f12 2918** fast-lock.el and lazy-lock.el are obsolete. Use jit-lock.el instead.
09fe18d3 2919
406c0f12
RS
2920---
2921** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead.
98a51048 2922
406c0f12
RS
2923---
2924** cplus-md.el has been removed to avoid problems with Custom.
2925\f
c44da964 2926* Changes in Emacs 22.1 on non-free operating systems
c1cbc25a 2927
ed2846bd 2928+++
406c0f12
RS
2929** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
2930You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
2931existing values. For example:
09fe18d3 2932
406c0f12 2933 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
09fe18d3 2934
406c0f12
RS
2935will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
2936irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
e5847e56 2937
406c0f12
RS
2938---
2939** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
2940This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
2941the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
e5847e56 2942
406c0f12
RS
2943---
2944** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
2945See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
e5847e56 2946
406c0f12
RS
2947---
2948** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
2949PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
2950depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
2951to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
2952http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
2953zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
2954against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
e5847e56 2955
406c0f12
RS
2956---
2957** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
2958WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
2959as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
2960Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
2961sound support for those formats.
06859ebd 2962
30b0da81 2963---
406c0f12
RS
2964** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
2965The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
06859ebd 2966
30b0da81 2967---
406c0f12
RS
2968** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
2969The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
2970whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
2971pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
678d2655 2972
30b0da81 2973---
406c0f12
RS
2974** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
2975The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
2976the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
2977colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
2978default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
2979some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
2980`list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
2981you wish to use them in other faces.
678d2655 2982
406c0f12
RS
2983---
2984** On MS Windows NT/W2K/XP, Emacs uses Unicode for clipboard operations.
2985Those systems use Unicode internally, so this allows Emacs to share
2986multilingual text with other applications. On other versions of
2987MS Windows, Emacs now uses the appropriate locale coding-system, so
2988the clipboard should work correctly for your local language without
2989any customizations.
06859ebd 2990
406c0f12
RS
2991---
2992** On Mac OS, the value of the variable `keyboard-coding-system' is
2993now dynamically changed according to the current keyboard script. The
2994variable `mac-keyboard-text-encoding' and the constants
2995`kTextEncodingMacRoman', `kTextEncodingISOLatin1', and
2996`kTextEncodingISOLatin2' are obsolete.
30b0da81
RS
2997\f
2998* Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
e71caa4e 2999
ed2846bd 3000+++
30b0da81
RS
3001** `suppress-keymap' now works by remapping `self-insert-command' to
3002the command `undefined'. (In earlier Emacs versions, it used
3003`substitute-key-definition' to rebind self inserting characters to
3004`undefined'.)
c1cbc25a 3005
30b0da81
RS
3006+++
3007** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3008:propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3009`risky-local-variable' property is nil.
c44da964
RS
3010
3011---
3012** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
30b0da81
RS
3013\f
3014* Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
c1cbc25a 3015
c44da964 3016** General Lisp changes:
c1cbc25a 3017
30b0da81 3018+++
c44da964 3019*** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
c1cbc25a 3020
ed2846bd 3021+++
c44da964 3022*** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
4e14f66c 3023
7e995a23 3024+++
c44da964
RS
3025*** If optional third argument APPEND to `add-to-list' is non-nil, a
3026new element gets added at the end of the list instead of at the
3027beginning. This change actually occurred in Emacs-21.1, but was not
3028documented.
d3a403e5 3029
11a365f9 3030+++
c44da964
RS
3031*** New function `copy-tree' makes a copy of a tree, recursively copying
3032both cars and cdrs.
b19ac475 3033
ed2846bd 3034+++
c44da964
RS
3035*** New function `delete-dups' destructively removes `equal'
3036duplicates from a list. Of several `equal' occurrences of an element
3037in the list, the first one is kept.
b2b681f1 3038
30b0da81 3039+++
c44da964
RS
3040*** `declare' is now a macro. This change was made mostly for
3041documentation purposes and should have no real effect on Lisp code.
b2b681f1 3042
30b0da81 3043+++
c44da964
RS
3044*** The new function `rassq-delete-all' deletes all elements from an
3045alist whose cdr is `eq' to a specified value.
b2b681f1 3046
30b0da81 3047+++
c44da964
RS
3048*** The function `number-sequence' returns a list of equally-separated
3049numbers. For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9).
3050By default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different separation
3051as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns (1.5 3.5 5.5).
b2b681f1 3052
30b0da81 3053+++
c44da964
RS
3054*** The variables `most-positive-fixnum' and `most-negative-fixnum'
3055hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
b2b681f1 3056
30b0da81 3057+++
c44da964
RS
3058*** The flags, width, and precision options for %-specifications in function
3059`format' are now documented. Some flags that were accepted but not
3060implemented (such as "*") are no longer accepted.
b2b681f1 3061
a775dff4 3062+++
c44da964
RS
3063*** Functions `get' and `plist-get' no longer signals an error for
3064a malformed property list. They also detect cyclic lists.
851e5562 3065
30b0da81 3066+++
c44da964
RS
3067*** The new functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put' are like
3068`plist-get' and `plist-put', except that they compare the property
3069name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
851e5562 3070
9f4b6e73 3071+++
c44da964
RS
3072*** The new variable `print-continuous-numbering', when non-nil, says
3073that successive calls to print functions should use the same
3074numberings for circular structure references. This is only relevant
3075when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3076
3077When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3078also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
e91408d7 3079
9f4b6e73 3080+++
c44da964 3081*** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
30b0da81 3082
c44da964
RS
3083It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
3084One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
3085if no expansion is done, which can be tested using `eq'.
8bc51bd1 3086
b19ac475 3087+++
c44da964
RS
3088*** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3089
3090When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3091angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3092equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
830047fd 3093
9adcb5f2 3094+++
c44da964 3095*** A function's doc string can now specify the calling pattern.
30b0da81 3096
c44da964
RS
3097You put this in the doc string's last line, which should match the
3098regexp "\n\n(fn.*)\\'".
d0cd7210 3099
3e7274ae 3100+++
c44da964 3101*** New macro `with-local-quit' temporarily sets `inhibit-quit' to nil.
3e7274ae 3102
c44da964
RS
3103This is for use around potentially blocking or long-running code in
3104timers and `post-command-hook' functions.
3105
3106*** `define-obsolete-function-alias'
3107combines `defalias' and `make-obsolete'.
7e995a23 3108
30b0da81 3109+++
c44da964
RS
3110*** New function `unsafep' returns nil if the given Lisp form can't
3111possibly do anything dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the
3112form might be unsafe (calls unknown function, alters global variable,
3113etc).
7e995a23 3114
c44da964 3115** Lisp code indentation features:
7e995a23 3116
a775dff4 3117+++
c44da964
RS
3118*** The `defmacro' form can contain declarations specifying how to
3119indent the macro in Lisp mode and how to debug it with Edebug. The
3120syntax of defmacro has been extended to
652dd271 3121
c44da964
RS
3122 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3123
3124DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3125declaration specifiers supported are:
3126
3127(indent INDENT)
3128 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3129
3130(edebug DEBUG)
3131 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3132 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro.
53092de4 3133
30b0da81 3134---
c44da964 3135*** cl-indent now allows customization of Indentation of backquoted forms.
d18473b9 3136
c44da964
RS
3137See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3138
3139---
3140*** cl-indent now handles indentation of simple and extended `loop' forms.
3141
3142The new user options `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation',
3143`lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can
3144be used to customize the indentation of keywords and forms in loop
3145forms.
69348b2a 3146
ed2846bd 3147+++
c44da964 3148** Variable aliases:
30b0da81
RS
3149
3150*** defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
3151
3152This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3153symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3154returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3155changes the value of BASE-VAR.
3156
3157DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3158the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3159
3160*** indirect-variable VARIABLE
3161
3162This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3163of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3164defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3165
3166It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3167variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
69348b2a 3168
ed2846bd 3169+++
c44da964
RS
3170*** The macro `define-obsolete-variable-alias' combines `defvaralias' and
3171`make-obsolete-variable'.
69348b2a 3172
c44da964 3173** defcustom changes:
69348b2a 3174
c44da964
RS
3175+++
3176*** defcustom and other custom declarations now use a default group
3177(the last prior group defined in the same file) when no :group was given.
69348b2a 3178
c44da964
RS
3179---
3180*** The new customization type `float' specifies numbers with floating
3181point (no integers are allowed).
69348b2a 3182
c44da964 3183** String changes:
30b0da81 3184
c44da964
RS
3185+++
3186*** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character,
3187unless it is followed by a `-' in a character constant (e.g. ?\s-A),
3188in which case it is still interpreted as the super modifier.
3189In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
30b0da81 3190
c44da964
RS
3191+++
3192*** A hex escape in a string forces the string to be multibyte.
3193An octal escape makes it unibyte.
30b0da81 3194
c44da964
RS
3195+++
3196*** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
3197the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
3198SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
3199nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
3200empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
30b0da81 3201
c44da964
RS
3202+++
3203*** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3204multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
30b0da81 3205
c44da964
RS
3206+++
3207*** New function `substring-no-properties returns a substring without
3208text properties.
30b0da81 3209
c44da964
RS
3210+++
3211*** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
3212`assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
3213been declared obsolete.
30b0da81 3214
c44da964 3215** Buffer/variable changes:
30b0da81 3216
c44da964
RS
3217+++
3218*** The new function `buffer-local-value' returns the buffer-local
3219binding of VARIABLE (a symbol) in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not
3220have a buffer-local binding in buffer BUFFER, it returns the default
3221value of VARIABLE instead.
30b0da81 3222
c44da964
RS
3223+++
3224** There is a new facility for displaying warnings to the user.
69348b2a 3225
c44da964 3226See the functions `warn' and `display-warning' .
5f6eef94 3227
c44da964
RS
3228+++
3229** Progress reporters.
5f6eef94 3230
c44da964
RS
3231These provide a simple and uniform way for commands to present
3232progress messages for the user.
05faee07 3233
c44da964
RS
3234See the new functions `make-progress-reporter',
3235`progress-reporter-update', `progress-reporter-force-update',
3236`progress-reporter-done', and `dotimes-with-progress-reporter'.
05faee07 3237
c44da964 3238** Buffer positions:
5f6eef94 3239
c44da964
RS
3240+++
3241*** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
3242width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
3243the usable window height and width is used.
5f6eef94 3244
c44da964
RS
3245+++
3246*** The `line-move', `scroll-up', and `scroll-down' functions will now
3247modify the window vscroll to scroll through display rows that are
3248taller that the height of the window, for example in the presense of
3249large images. To disable this feature, Lisp code can bind the new
3250variable `auto-window-vscroll' to nil.
5f6eef94 3251
c44da964
RS
3252+++
3253*** The argument to `forward-word', `backward-word',
3254`forward-to-indentation' and `backward-to-indentation' is now
3255optional, and defaults to 1.
5f6eef94 3256
c44da964
RS
3257+++
3258*** Lisp code can now test if a given buffer position is inside a
3259clickable link with the new function `mouse-on-link-p'. This is the
3260function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link' functionality.
5f6eef94 3261
c44da964
RS
3262+++
3263*** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns the line number of the
3264current line in the current buffer, or if optional buffer position is
3265given, line number of corresponding line in current buffer.
d46aeafc 3266
c44da964
RS
3267+++
3268*** `field-beginning' and `field-end' now accept an additional optional
3269argument, LIMIT.
d46aeafc 3270
c44da964
RS
3271+++
3272*** Function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now returns the pixel coordinates
3273and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
3274arg is non-nil.
05faee07 3275
c44da964
RS
3276+++
3277*** New functions `posn-at-point' and `posn-at-x-y' return
3278click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
3279position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
d46aeafc 3280
c44da964 3281** Text modification:
5f6eef94 3282
c44da964
RS
3283+++
3284*** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-as-yank' works like
3285`insert-buffer-substring', but removes the text properties in the
3286`yank-excluded-properties' list.
5f6eef94 3287
76bf15e9 3288+++
c44da964
RS
3289*** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-no-properties' is like
3290insert-buffer-substring, but removes all text properties from the
3291inserted substring.
76bf15e9 3292
c44da964
RS
3293+++
3294*** The new function `filter-buffer-substring' extracts a buffer
3295substring, passes it through a set of filter functions, and returns
3296the filtered substring. It is used instead of `buffer-substring' or
3297`delete-and-extract-region' when copying text into a user-accessible
3298data structure, like the kill-ring, X clipboard, or a register. The
3299list of filter function is specified by the new variable
3300`buffer-substring-filters'. For example, Longlines mode uses
3301`buffer-substring-filters' to remove soft newlines from the copied
3302text.
06a49fc1 3303
c44da964
RS
3304+++
3305*** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
3306argument.
c6177909 3307
c44da964
RS
3308+++
3309*** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3310is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3311be inserted is translated through it.
01b70437 3312
c44da964
RS
3313---
3314*** Text clones.
4a29bad2 3315
c44da964
RS
3316The new function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3317that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3318clone to the other.
0e7d7aae 3319
c44da964
RS
3320---
3321*** The function `insert-string' is now obsolete.
f6537e03 3322
c44da964 3323** Syntax table changes:
f6537e03 3324
c44da964
RS
3325+++
3326*** The macro `with-syntax-table' does not copy the table any more.
c6de56a0 3327
c44da964
RS
3328+++
3329*** The new function `syntax-after' returns the syntax code
3330of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
3331of text properties as well as the character code.
c6de56a0 3332
c44da964
RS
3333+++
3334*** `syntax-class' extracts the class of a syntax code (as returned
3335by syntax-after).
bf078377 3336
c44da964
RS
3337*** The new package `syntax.el' provides an efficient way to find the
3338current syntactic context (as returned by `parse-partial-sexp').
9c0fb8b9 3339
c44da964 3340** GC changes:
51a8b435
RS
3341
3342+++
c44da964
RS
3343*** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
3344on garbage collection.
3345
3346+++
3347*** Functions from `post-gc-hook' are run at the end of garbage
3348collection. The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
3349
3350** Buffer-related changes:
3351
3352---
3353*** `list-buffers-noselect' now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
3354If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
3355
3356+++
3357*** `kill-buffer-hook' is now a permanent local.
3358
3359** Local variables lists:
3360
3361+++
3362*** Text properties in local variables.
3363
3364A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
3365properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
3366
3367+++
3368*** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3369are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3370specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3371such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3372needed.
3373
3374---
3375*** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3376that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3377appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3378is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3379ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3380with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3381
3382If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3383confirmation as before.
3384
3385** Abbrev changes:
3386
3387*** The new function copy-abbrev-table returns a new abbrev table that
3388is a copy of a given abbrev table.
3389
3390+++
3391*** define-abbrev now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG. If
3392non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means that
3393it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the abbrevs.
3394Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always specify this
3395flag.
3396
3397** Undo changes:
3398
3399+++
3400*** An element of buffer-undo-list can now have the form (apply FUNNAME
3401. ARGS), where FUNNAME is a symbol other than t or nil. That stands
3402for a high-level change that should be undone by evaluating (apply
3403FUNNAME ARGS).
3404
3405These entries can also have the form (apply DELTA BEG END FUNNAME . ARGS)
3406which indicates that the change which took place was limited to the
3407range BEG...END and increased the buffer size by DELTA.
3408
3409+++
3410*** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
3411undo-outer-limit, garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
3412it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
9c0fb8b9 3413
51a8b435 3414+++
da9356b0 3415** New `yank-handler' text property can be used to control how
30b0da81 3416previously killed text on the kill-ring is reinserted.
c64a682c 3417
30b0da81
RS
3418The value of the yank-handler property must be a list with one to four
3419elements with the following format:
3420 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
c64a682c 3421
30b0da81
RS
3422The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
3423the first character on its string argument (typically the first
3424element on the kill-ring). If a yank-handler property is found,
3425the normal behavior of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
c6de56a0 3426
30b0da81
RS
3427 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
3428to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
3429 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
3430passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
3431`yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
3432rectangle.
3433 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
3434yank-excluded-properties is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
3435responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
3436if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
3437 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
3438by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
3439called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
da9356b0 3440FUNCTION can set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
c6de56a0 3441
30b0da81
RS
3442*** The functions kill-new, kill-append, and kill-region now have an
3443optional argument to specify the yank-handler text property to put on
3444the killed text.
c6de56a0 3445
30b0da81
RS
3446*** The function yank-pop will now use a non-nil value of the variable
3447`yank-undo-function' (instead of delete-region) to undo the previous
3448yank or yank-pop command (or a call to insert-for-yank). The function
3449insert-for-yank automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
3450element of the string argument's yank-handler text property if present.
c6de56a0 3451
30b0da81
RS
3452*** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
3453`yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
3454string. The old behavior is available if you call
3455`insert-for-yank-1' instead.
c6de56a0 3456
30b0da81
RS
3457*** The new function insert-for-yank normally works like `insert', but
3458removes the text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list.
da9356b0 3459However, the insertion of the text can be modified by a `yank-handler'
30b0da81 3460text property.
c6de56a0 3461
c44da964 3462** File operation changes:
5ceea398 3463
c44da964
RS
3464+++
3465*** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
3466searching for an executable resp. an elisp file.
5ceea398 3467
51a8b435 3468+++
c44da964
RS
3469*** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
3470modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
3471operation.
052797a7 3472
51a8b435 3473+++
c44da964
RS
3474*** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
3475non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
3476its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
3477The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
30b0da81 3478
c44da964
RS
3479+++
3480*** `auto-save-file-format' has been renamed to
3481`buffer-auto-save-file-format' and made into a permanent local.
3482
3483+++
3484*** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
3485ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
3486`.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
3487
3488+++
3489*** copy-file now takes an additional option arg MUSTBENEW.
3490
3491This argument works like the MUSTBENEW argument of write-file.
3492
3493+++
3494*** If the second argument to `copy-file' is the name of a directory,
3495the file is copied to that directory instead of signaling an error.
3496
3497+++
3498*** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
3499a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
3500
3501+++
3502*** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
3503specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
3504many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
3505`file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
3506
3507+++
3508*** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
3509before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
3510tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
3511sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
3512
3513+++
3514*** If a buffer sets buffer-save-without-query to non-nil,
3515save-some-buffers will always save that buffer without asking
3516(if it's modified).
3517
3518*** New function `locate-file' searches for a file in a list of directories.
3519`locate-file' accepts a name of a file to search (a string), and two
3520lists: a list of directories to search in and a list of suffixes to
3521try; typical usage might use `exec-path' and `load-path' for the list
3522of directories, and `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' for the list
3523of suffixes. The function also accepts a predicate argument to
3524further filter candidate files.
3525
3526One advantage of using this function is that the list of suffixes in
3527`exec-suffixes' is OS-dependant, so this function will find
3528executables without polluting Lisp code with OS dependancies.
3529
3530---
3531*** The precedence of file-name-handlers has been changed.
3532Instead of blindly choosing the first handler that matches,
3533find-file-name-handler now gives precedence to a file-name handler
3534that matches near the end of the file name. More specifically, the
3535handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen.
3536In case of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
3537
3538+++
3539*** A file name handler can declare which operations it handles.
3540
3541You do this by putting an `operation' property on the handler name
3542symbol. The property value should be a list of the operations that
3543the handler really handles. It won't be called for any other
3544operations.
3545
3546This is useful for autoloaded handlers, to prevent them from being
3547autoloaded when not really necessary.
3548
3549** Input changes:
3550
3551+++
3552*** An interactive specification can now use the code letter 'U' to get
3553the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
3554previous 'k' or 'K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
3555
3556+++
3557*** The new interactive-specification `G' reads a file name
3558much like `F', but if the input is a directory name (even defaulted),
3559it returns just the directory name.
3560
3561---
3562*** Functions y-or-n-p, read-char, read-key-sequence and the like, that
3563display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
3564using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
3565
3566+++
3567*** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
3568arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
3569quit had occurred. while-no-input returns the value of BODY, if BODY
3570finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted.
3571
3572** Minibuffer changes:
3573
3574*** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional
3575buffer argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted, it
3576defaults to the current buffer.
3577
3578+++
3579*** New function minibuffer-selected-window returns the window which
3580was selected when entering the minibuffer.
3581
3582+++
3583*** read-from-minibuffer now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
3584saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
3585
3586+++
3587*** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
3588specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
3589new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
3590while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
3591variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
3592
3593---
3594*** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by lisp code
3595to override the internal read-file-name function.
3596
3597+++
3598*** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
3599whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
3600`read-file-name' function.
3601
3602+++
3603*** The new function `read-directory-name' can be used instead of
3604`read-file-name' to read a directory name; when used, completion
3605will only show directories.
3606
3607** Searching and matching changes:
3608
3609+++
3610*** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
3611the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
3612back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
3613
3614+++
3615*** The new variable search-spaces-regexp controls how to search
3616for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
3617regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
3618expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
3619
3620Spaces inside of constructs such as [..] and *, +, ? are never
3621replaced with search-spaces-regexp.
3622
3623+++
3624*** There are now two new regular expression operators, \_< and \_>,
3625for matching the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
3626non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
3627specified by the syntax table.
3628
3629+++
3630*** skip-chars-forward and skip-chars-backward now handle
3631character classes such as [:alpha:], along with individual characters
3632and ranges.
3633
3634---
3635*** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
3636properties from surrounding text.
3637
3638+++
3639*** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
3640element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
3641accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
3642
3643---
3644*** rx.el has new corresponding `symbol-end' and `symbol-start' elements.
3645
3646+++
3647*** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
3648variable `sentence-end-without-space', which contains such characters
3649that end a sentence without following spaces.
3650
3651The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of the
3652variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil, then
3653this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
3654`sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
3655`sentence-end-without-space'.
3656
3657+++
3658** Enhancements to keymaps.
3659
3660*** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
3661
3662You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
3663same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
3664example,
3665
3666(kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
3667
3668*** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
3669
3670This is an alternative to using defadvice or substitute-key-definition
3671to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
3672binding and lookup functionality.
3673
3674When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
3675remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
3676original command.
3677
3678Example:
3679Suppose that minor mode my-mode has defined the commands
3680my-kill-line and my-kill-word, and it wants C-k (and any other key
3681bound to kill-line) to run the command my-kill-line instead of
3682kill-line, and likewise it wants to run my-kill-word instead of
3683kill-word.
3684
3685Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
3686command remapping allows you to directly map kill-line into
3687my-kill-line and kill-word into my-kill-word through the minor mode
3688map using define-key:
3689
3690 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
3691 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
3692
3693Now, when my-mode is enabled, and the user enters C-k or M-d,
3694the commands my-kill-line and my-kill-word are run.
3695
3696Notice that only one level of remapping is supported. In the above
3697example, this means that if my-kill-line is remapped to other-kill,
3698then C-k still runs my-kill-line.
3699
3700The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
3701
3702- Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
3703 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
3704 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
3705 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
3706
3707- The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
3708 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
3709
3710- key-binding now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
3711 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
3712
3713- where-is-internal now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
3714 kill-line if my-mode is enabled), and the actual key binding for
3715 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
3716 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
3717 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns C-k for kill-line and
3718 <kill-line> for my-kill-line).
3719
3720- The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
3721 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
3722 command was not remapped.
3723
3724*** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
3725over minor mode keymaps.
3726
3727*** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
3728text-properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
3729works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
3730
3731*** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
3732Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
3733bindings of the parent keymap.
3734
3735*** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
3736
3737*** New function `current-active-maps' returns a list of currently
3738active keymaps.
3739
3740*** New function `describe-buffer-bindings' inserts the list of all
3741defined keys and their definitions.
3742
3743*** New function `keymap-prompt' returns the prompt-string of a keymap
3744
3745*** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
3746in the keymap.
3747
3748*** New variable emulation-mode-map-alists.
3749
3750Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
3751keymap alist separate from minor-mode-map-alist by adding their keymap
3752alist to this list.
3753
3754+++
3755** Atomic change groups.
3756
3757To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3758they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3759around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3760
3761 (atomic-change-group
3762 (insert foo)
3763 (delete-region x y))
3764
3765If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3766`atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3767were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3768on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3769
3770If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3771lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3772
3773To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3774Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3775This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3776the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3777
3778Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3779group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3780do this.
3781
3782After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3783either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3784`accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3785call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3786
3787You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3788finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3789`unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3790(This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3791`activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3792group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3793twice.
3794
3795To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3796for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3797returned values, like this:
3798
3799 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3800 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3801
3802You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3803to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3804`accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3805
3806Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3807would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3808will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3809change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3810finished.
3811
3812+++
3813** Enhancements to process support
3814
3815*** Function list-processes now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
3816only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set are listed.
30b0da81
RS
3817
3818*** New set-process-query-on-exit-flag and process-query-on-exit-flag
3819functions. The existing process-kill-without-query function is still
3820supported, but new code should use the new functions.
3821
3822*** Function signal-process now accepts a process object or process
3823name in addition to a process id to identify the signalled process.
3824
3825*** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
3826maintain process state and other per-process related information.
3827
3828The new functions process-get and process-put are used to access, add,
3829and modify elements on this property list.
052797a7 3830
30b0da81
RS
3831The new low-level functions process-plist and set-process-plist are
3832used to access and replace the entire property list of a process.
052797a7 3833
30b0da81
RS
3834*** Function accept-process-output now has an optional fourth arg
3835`just-this-one'. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
3836is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
3837integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
3838recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
3839speech synthesis.
211a9f6b 3840
30b0da81 3841*** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
eb67c5d6 3842
30b0da81
RS
3843On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
3844output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
3845very poor performance. This behavior can be remedied to some extent
3846by setting the new variable process-adaptive-read-buffering to a
3847non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
3848from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
3849emacs tries to read it.
b0ada147 3850
c44da964
RS
3851*** The new function `call-process-shell-command'.
3852
3853This executes a shell command command synchronously in a separate
3854process.
32d0a9dc 3855
30b0da81
RS
3856*** The new function `process-file' is similar to `call-process', but
3857obeys file handlers. The file handler is chosen based on
c44da964 3858`default-directory'.
ce4254bd 3859
30b0da81
RS
3860*** A filter function of a process is called with a multibyte string
3861if the filter's multibyteness is t. That multibyteness is decided by
3862the value of `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is
ce4254bd
KH
3863created and can be changed later by `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
3864
c44da964
RS
3865*** The new function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the
3866multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
3867
3868*** The new function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns the
3869multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
3870
3871*** If a process's coding system is `raw-text' or `no-conversion' and its
ce4254bd
KH
3872buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
3873to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
3874Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
4e07258f 3875which was not compatible with the behavior of file reading.
ce4254bd 3876
e50886d3 3877+++
30b0da81 3878** Enhanced networking support.
b08d5f59 3879
30b0da81
RS
3880*** There is a new `make-network-process' function which supports
3881opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
3882create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
6eed9bed 3883
30b0da81
RS
3884- A server is started using :server t arg.
3885- Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
3886- A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
3887- Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
3888- Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
da9356b0 3889- The process' property list can be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
30b0da81
RS
3890 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
3891 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
b6c2aa59 3892
30b0da81
RS
3893To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
3894 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
175573ac 3895
30b0da81 3896*** Original open-network-stream is now emulated using make-network-process.
2155ecf3 3897
30b0da81 3898*** New function open-network-stream-nowait.
2155ecf3 3899
30b0da81
RS
3900This function initiates a non-blocking connect and returns immediately
3901without waiting for the connection to be established. It takes the
3902filter and sentinel functions as arguments; when the non-blocking
3903connect completes, the sentinel is called with a status string
3904matching "open" or "failed".
f08830d2 3905
30b0da81 3906*** New function open-network-stream-server.
f08830d2 3907
30b0da81
RS
3908This function creates a network server process for a TCP service.
3909When a client connects to the specified service, a new subprocess
3910is created to handle the new connection, and the sentinel function
3911is called for the new process.
f08830d2 3912
30b0da81 3913*** New functions process-datagram-address and set-process-datagram-address.
f08830d2 3914
30b0da81
RS
3915These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
3916and set the current address of the remote partner.
c60ee5e7 3917
30b0da81 3918*** New function format-network-address.
e50886d3 3919
30b0da81
RS
3920This function reformats the lisp representation of a network address
3921to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
3922number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
3923printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
3924string for other formatting options.
a4ac5b17 3925
30b0da81
RS
3926*** By default, the function process-contact still returns (HOST SERVICE)
3927for a network process. Using the new optional KEY arg, the complete list
3928of network process properties or a specific property can be selected.
9252f7bc 3929
30b0da81
RS
3930Using :local and :remote as the KEY, the address of the local or
3931remote end-point is returned. An Inet address is represented as a 5
3932element vector, where the first 4 elements contain the IP address and
3933the fifth is the port number.
56011a8c 3934
30b0da81
RS
3935*** Network processes can now be stopped and restarted with
3936`stop-process' and `continue-process'. For a server process, no
3937connections are accepted in the stopped state. For a client process,
3938no input is received in the stopped state.
d2d70cb6 3939
30b0da81 3940*** New function network-interface-list.
d2d70cb6 3941
30b0da81
RS
3942This function returns a list of network interface names and their
3943current network addresses.
d2d70cb6 3944
30b0da81 3945*** New function network-interface-info.
d2d70cb6 3946
30b0da81
RS
3947This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
3948status, and other information about a specific network interface.
e50886d3 3949
30b0da81
RS
3950*** The sentinel is now called when a network process is deleted with
3951delete-process. The status message passed to the sentinel for a
3952deleted network process is "deleted". The message passed to the
3953sentinel when the connection is closed by the remote peer has been
3954changed to "connection broken by remote peer".
3116d142 3955
c44da964 3956** Using window objects:
7c3cb37d 3957
21beb82f 3958+++
c44da964 3959*** New function `window-body-height'.
add89676 3960
c44da964
RS
3961This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line or the
3962header line.
add89676 3963
a775dff4 3964+++
c44da964 3965*** New function `window-body-height'.
3bd7a6ed 3966
c44da964
RS
3967This is like window-height but does not count the mode line
3968or the header line.
2cb72935
RS
3969
3970+++
3971*** You can now make a window as short as one line.
3972
3973A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
3974line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
3975`header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
3976cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
3977variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
3978
30b0da81 3979+++
2cb72935 3980*** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
30b0da81
RS
3981actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
3982divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
3983the mode line.
3bd7a6ed 3984
30b0da81 3985+++
2cb72935 3986*** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
30b0da81 3987return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
3bd7a6ed 3988
e50886d3 3989+++
2cb72935 3990*** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
c44da964 3991selected window without impacting the order of `buffer-list'.
02ce3e80 3992
30b0da81 3993+++
c44da964
RS
3994*** `select-window' takes an optional second argument `norecord'.
3995
3996This is like `switch-to-buffer'.
fc2938d1 3997
e50886d3 3998+++
2cb72935 3999*** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
30b0da81
RS
4000of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
4001by calling `select-window'.
79fab26b 4002
c5e0561f 4003+++
c44da964
RS
4004*** `set-window-buffer' has an optional argument KEEP-MARGINS.
4005
4006If non-nil, that says to preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
4007and scroll-bar settings.
56592beb 4008
e50886d3 4009+++
30b0da81 4010** Customizable fringe bitmaps
a7bd9dc7 4011
c44da964 4012*** New function `define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
30b0da81 4013fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
1c6576ab 4014
30b0da81
RS
4015To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
4016identifing the bitmap such as `left-truncation or `continued-line'.
2b6bb1f2 4017
c44da964
RS
4018*** New function `destroy-fringe-bitmap' deletes a fringe bitmap
4019or restores a built-in one to its default value.
cc305a60 4020
c44da964 4021*** New function `set-fringe-bitmap-face' can now be used to set a
30b0da81
RS
4022specific face to be used for a specific fringe bitmap. The face is
4023automatically merged with the `fringe' face, so normally, the face
4024should only specify the foreground color of the bitmap.
2b6bb1f2 4025
c44da964 4026*** There are new display properties, `left-fringe; and `right-fringe',
30b0da81
RS
4027that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
4028bitmap of the display line.
2b6bb1f2 4029
c44da964 4030Format is `display (left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])', where BITMAP is a
30b0da81
RS
4031symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
4032`define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
4033for displaying the bitmap instead of the default `fringe' face.
4034When specified, FACE is automatically merged with the `fringe' face.
4035
4036*** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
4037bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
2b6bb1f2 4038
c44da964
RS
4039** Other window fringe features:
4040
c5e0561f 4041+++
c44da964 4042*** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
2b6bb1f2 4043
6f8968c8
KS
4044The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
4045can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
4046frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
4047Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
2b6bb1f2 4048
6f8968c8
KS
4049The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
4050specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
4051integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
4052between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
4053specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
4054only the left fringe gets the specified width).
2b6bb1f2
RS
4055
4056Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
4057width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
4058of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
4059fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
4060
c5e0561f 4061+++
c44da964 4062*** Per-window fringe and scrollbar settings
6f8968c8 4063
c44da964 4064**** Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and
30b0da81 4065position settings.
6f8968c8
KS
4066
4067To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
4068variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
4069`set-window-fringes'.
4070
4071To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
4072are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
4073or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
4074`fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
4075
4076The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
4077settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
4078`fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
4079displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
4080an update of the display margins.
4081
c44da964 4082**** Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
6f8968c8
KS
4083controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
4084
c44da964
RS
4085To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
4086variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
4087`set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
4088used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
4089`scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
4090the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
4091of the display margins.
93607efd 4092
c44da964 4093** Redisplay features:
93607efd 4094
30b0da81 4095+++
c44da964 4096*** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
93607efd 4097
30b0da81 4098+++
c44da964
RS
4099*** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
4100one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
4101contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
4102changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
4103forcing an explicit window update.
93607efd 4104
30b0da81 4105+++
c44da964 4106*** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
30b0da81
RS
4107to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
4108a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
93607efd 4109
30b0da81 4110Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
da9356b0 4111does that, this value cannot be accurate.
93607efd 4112
30b0da81 4113+++
c44da964
RS
4114*** You can define multiple overlay arrows via the new
4115variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'.
93607efd 4116
c44da964
RS
4117It contains a list of varibles which contain overlay arrow position
4118markers, including the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
93607efd 4119
c44da964
RS
4120Each variable on this list can have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
4121and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
4122string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
4123systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
4124If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
4125'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
3f21fb3a 4126
30b0da81 4127+++
c44da964 4128*** New `line-height' and `line-spacing' properties for newline characters
3f21fb3a 4129
c44da964
RS
4130A newline can now have `line-height' and `line-spacing' text or overlay
4131properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
108eaabb 4132
c44da964
RS
4133If the `line-height' property value is t, the newline does not
4134contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
4135newline glyph is reduced. Also, a `line-spacing' property on this
4136newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
4137slices without adding blank areas between the images.
108eaabb 4138
c44da964
RS
4139If the `line-height' property value is a positive integer, the value
4140specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
4141height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
108eaabb 4142
c44da964
RS
4143If the `line-height' property value is a float, the minimum line
4144height is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by
4145the given value.
108eaabb 4146
c44da964
RS
4147If the `line-height' property value is a cons (FACE . RATIO), the
4148minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
4149RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
108eaabb 4150
c44da964
RS
4151If the `line-height' property value is a cons (nil . RATIO), the line
4152height is calculated as RATIO * actual height of the line's contents.
108eaabb 4153
c44da964
RS
4154If the `line-height' value is a cons (HEIGHT . TOTAL), HEIGHT specifies
4155the line height as described above, while TOTAL is any of the forms
4156described above and specifies the total height of the line, causing a
4157varying number of pixels to be inserted after the line to make it line
4158exactly that many pixels high.
108eaabb 4159
c44da964
RS
4160If the `line-spacing' property value is an positive integer, the value
4161is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
4162overrides the default frame `line-spacing' and any buffer local value of
4163the `line-spacing' variable.
108eaabb 4164
c44da964
RS
4165If the `line-spacing' property is a float or cons, the line spacing
4166is calculated as specified above for the `line-height' property.
108eaabb 4167
30b0da81 4168+++
c44da964
RS
4169*** The buffer local line-spacing variable can now have a float value,
4170which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
108eaabb 4171
30b0da81 4172+++
c44da964 4173*** Enhancements to stretch display properties
108eaabb 4174
c44da964
RS
4175The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
4176PROPS is a property list now allows pixel based width and height
4177specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
f17c0a19 4178
c44da964
RS
4179The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
4180which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
4181are supported:
f17c0a19 4182
c44da964
RS
4183EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
4184NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
4185UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
4186ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
4187 | scroll-bar | text
4188POS ::= left | center | right
4189FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
4190OP ::= + | -
f17c0a19 4191
c44da964
RS
4192The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
4193frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
4194pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
4195is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
4196pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
4197`height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
4198font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
4199the image.
d9f7eb77 4200
c44da964
RS
4201The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
4202`scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
4203corresponding area of the window.
d9f7eb77 4204
c44da964
RS
4205The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
4206to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
4207of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
4208can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
4209relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
4210a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
4211these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
4212the width of the area.
d278091b 4213
c44da964
RS
4214For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
4215 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
18232c16 4216
c44da964
RS
4217If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
4218to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
4219header-line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
18232c16 4220
c44da964
RS
4221The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
4222the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
4223width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
4224height) of the specified image.
d278091b 4225
c44da964
RS
4226The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
4227The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
d278091b 4228
30b0da81 4229+++
c44da964
RS
4230*** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
4231text property string that may be present at the current window
4232position. The cursor can now be placed on any character of such
4233strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
18232c16 4234
0e7d7aae 4235+++
c44da964
RS
4236*** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
4237supported on text terminals.
18232c16 4238
30b0da81 4239+++
c44da964 4240*** Support for displaying image slices
18232c16 4241
c44da964
RS
4242**** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) can be used with
4243an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
18232c16 4244
c44da964
RS
4245**** Function insert-image has new optional fourth arg to
4246specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
18232c16 4247
c44da964
RS
4248**** New function insert-sliced-image inserts a given image as a
4249specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
18232c16 4250
a775dff4 4251+++
c44da964 4252*** Images can now have an associated image map via the :map property.
18232c16 4253
c44da964
RS
4254An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
4255An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
4256A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((X0 . Y0) . (X1 . Y1))) specifying the
4257pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
4258A circle is a cons (circle . ((X0 . Y0) . R)) specifying the center
4259and the radius of the circle; R can be a float or integer.
4260A polygon is a cons (poly . [X0 Y0 X1 Y1 ...]) where each pair in the
4261vector describes one corner in the polygon.
11ef2a3b 4262
c44da964
RS
4263When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
4264PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
4265property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
4266a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
4267it is over the hot-spot. See the variable 'void-area-text-pointer'
4268for possible pointer shapes.
11ef2a3b 4269
c44da964
RS
4270When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
4271an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
4272mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
7e07a66d 4273
c44da964 4274** Mouse pointer features:
3d619ea1 4275
c44da964
RS
4276+++ (lispref)
4277??? (man)
4278*** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
4279line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
4280controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
4281is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
4282(or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
3d619ea1 4283
85df292e 4284+++
c44da964
RS
4285*** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
4286:pointer image property.
a0a23346 4287
f6537e03 4288+++
c44da964
RS
4289*** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images can now be
4290controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
15aeeda5 4291
c44da964 4292** Mouse event enhancements:
15aeeda5 4293
30b0da81 4294+++
c44da964
RS
4295*** Mouse clicks on fringes now generates left-fringe or right-fringes
4296events, rather than a text area click event.
e519464c 4297
30b0da81 4298+++
c44da964
RS
4299*** Mouse clicks in the left and right marginal areas now includes a
4300sensible buffer position corresponding to the first character in the
4301corresponding text row.
e519464c 4302
30b0da81 4303+++
c44da964 4304*** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
101c421e 4305
c44da964
RS
4306+++
4307*** Mouse events now includes buffer position for all event types.
31e0fbdd 4308
30b0da81 4309+++
c44da964 4310*** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
31e0fbdd 4311
f6537e03 4312+++
c44da964
RS
4313*** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
4314text area).
1e892206 4315
30b0da81 4316+++
c44da964 4317*** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types.
1e892206 4318
30b0da81 4319+++
c44da964 4320*** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns actual glyph coordinates.
1e892206 4321
c44da964
RS
4322+++
4323*** Mouse events can now include image object in addition to string object.
60a501d7 4324
c44da964
RS
4325+++
4326*** Mouse events include relative x and y pixel coordinates relative to
4327the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
fd13a3cc 4328
c44da964
RS
4329+++
4330*** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
4331(image or character) clicked on.
fd13a3cc 4332
c44da964
RS
4333+++
4334*** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', and
4335'posn-object-width-height' return the image or string object of a mouse
4336click, the x and y pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner
4337of that object, and the total width and height of that object.
fd13a3cc 4338
c44da964 4339** Text property and overlay changes:
8e9e520b 4340
c44da964
RS
4341+++
4342*** Arguments for remove-overlays are now optional, so that you can
4343remove all overlays in the buffer by just calling (remove-overlays).
30b0da81 4344
c44da964
RS
4345+++
4346*** New variable char-property-alias-alist.
30b0da81 4347
c44da964
RS
4348This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
4349properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
4350although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
4351to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
30b0da81
RS
4352
4353+++
c44da964
RS
4354*** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
4355arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
4356return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
4357whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
4358it was found as a text property or not found at all.
fd13a3cc 4359
30b0da81 4360+++
c44da964
RS
4361*** The new function remove-list-of-text-properties is almost the same
4362as `remove-text-properties'. The only difference is that it takes a
4363list of property names as argument rather than a property list.
8e9e520b 4364
c44da964 4365** Face changes
fd13a3cc 4366
30b0da81 4367+++
c44da964
RS
4368*** The new face attribute condition `min-colors' can be used to tailor
4369the face color to the number of colors supported by a display, and
4370define the foreground and background colors accordingly so that they
4371look best on a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This
4372is now the preferred method for defining default faces in a way that
4373makes a good use of the capabilities of the display.
fd13a3cc 4374
c44da964
RS
4375+++
4376*** New function display-supports-face-attributes-p can be used to test
4377whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
fd13a3cc 4378
c44da964
RS
4379A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
4380specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
4381defined with defface.
fd13a3cc 4382
30b0da81 4383---
c44da964
RS
4384*** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
4385or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
4386`defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
4387the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
4388directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
205f1dde 4389
30b0da81 4390+++
c44da964
RS
4391*** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
4392`default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
4393defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and can be overridden
4394by them).
205f1dde 4395
c44da964
RS
4396+++
4397*** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
4398(or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
4399'((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
4400point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
4401SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
205f1dde 4402
30b0da81 4403---
c44da964
RS
4404*** The function `face-differs-from-default-p' now truly checks
4405whether the given face displays differently from the default face or
4406not (previously it did only a very cursory check).
205f1dde 4407
f6537e03 4408+++
c44da964
RS
4409*** `face-attribute', `face-foreground', `face-background', and
4410`face-stipple' now accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which
4411controls how face inheritance is used when determining the value of a
4412face attribute.
6ba3d6bc 4413
f6537e03 4414+++
c44da964
RS
4415*** New functions `face-attribute-relative-p' and `merge-face-attribute'
4416help with handling relative face attributes.
9ade4a7d 4417
f6537e03 4418+++
c44da964 4419*** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face list is reversed.
3bdb7f80 4420
c44da964
RS
4421If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
4422faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous
4423releases of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made
4424so that :inherit face lists operate identically to face lists in text
4425`face' properties.
4e3dd7cf 4426
a775dff4 4427+++
c44da964 4428*** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
213856ba 4429
f6537e03 4430---
c44da964
RS
4431*** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
4432the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
f6078b98 4433
c44da964 4434** Font-Lock changes:
f6078b98 4435
0e7d7aae 4436+++
c44da964 4437*** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
f6078b98 4438
c44da964
RS
4439This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
4440M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
4441property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
4442new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
2a1e884e 4443
30b0da81 4444+++
c44da964 4445*** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
2a1e884e 4446
c44da964
RS
4447*** the FACENAME returned in `font-lock-keywords' can be a list of the
4448form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set other
4449properties than `face'.
2a1e884e 4450
c44da964
RS
4451*** `font-lock-extra-managed-props' can be set to make sure those
4452extra properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
30b0da81
RS
4453
4454---
c44da964 4455*** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
596d02bc 4456
c44da964
RS
4457If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
4458(see `jit-lock-defer-contextually'), then all of that text will
4459be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
4460depends on text several lines further down (and when `font-lock-multiline'
4461is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
596d02bc 4462
c44da964
RS
4463 s{
4464 foo
4465 }{
4466 bar
4467 }e
d33c4505 4468
c44da964
RS
4469Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
4470text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a `jit-lock-defer-multiline'
4471property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
4472refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
21b6d966 4473
c44da964 4474** Major mode mechanism changes:
21b6d966 4475
9f89426b 4476+++
c44da964
RS
4477*** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
4478precedence over the file name. Likewise an `<?xml' or `<!DOCTYPE'
4479declaration will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new
4480var `magic-mode-alist'.
9f89426b 4481
0e7d7aae 4482+++
c44da964
RS
4483*** Major mode functions now run the new normal hook
4484`after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode hooks.
9356fe5a 4485
c44da964
RS
4486---
4487*** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
4488property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
4489it in that buffer.
4f4fada2 4490
30b0da81 4491+++
c44da964
RS
4492*** Major modes can define `eldoc-documentation-function'
4493locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
4494the language.
4f4fada2 4495
c4f59bcf 4496+++
c44da964
RS
4497*** `define-derived-mode' by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
4498It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
c4f59bcf 4499
75e20bec 4500+++
c44da964
RS
4501*** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
4502are used by `define-derived-mode' to make sure the mode hook for the
4503parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
75e20bec 4504
c44da964 4505** Minor mode changes:
e0c124ce 4506
bc3b02f9 4507+++
c44da964
RS
4508*** `define-minor-mode' now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
4509and simply passes them to `defcustom', if applicable.
bc3b02f9 4510
5df034de 4511+++
c44da964 4512*** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
5df034de 4513
1c6576ab 4514---
c44da964 4515*** `define-global-minor-mode'.
1c6576ab 4516
c44da964
RS
4517This is a new name for what was formerly called
4518`easy-mmode-define-global-mode'. The old name remains as an alias.
f67cc62e 4519
c44da964 4520** Command loop changes:
f67cc62e 4521
30b0da81 4522+++
c44da964
RS
4523*** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
4524have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' did: it returns t if the
4525calling function was called through `call-interactively'. This should
4526only be used when you cannot solve the problem by adding a new
4527INTERACTIVE argument to the command.
6710ea06 4528
a775dff4 4529+++
c44da964 4530*** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional argument.
16927a56 4531
c44da964
RS
4532If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks for a function that could be
4533called with `call-interactively', and does not return t for keyboard
4534macros.
30b0da81 4535
51a8b435 4536+++
c44da964
RS
4537*** When a command returns, the command loop moves point out from
4538within invisible text, in the same way it moves out from within text
4539covered by an image or composition property.
16927a56 4540
c44da964
RS
4541This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
4542This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
4543unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
4544(including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
4545`post-command-hook' and thus does not care about intermediate states.
8727d588 4546
30b0da81 4547+++
c44da964
RS
4548*** If a command sets `transient-mark-mode' to `only', that
4549enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
4550During that following command, the value of `transient-mark-mode'
4551is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
4552the next return to the command loop changes to nil.
1c1d3d69 4553
30b0da81 4554+++
c44da964
RS
4555*** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
4556been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
4557`disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
1c1d3d69 4558
bcdf2143 4559+++
c44da964
RS
4560*** `emacsserver' now runs `pre-command-hook' and `post-command-hook'
4561when it receives a request from emacsclient.
bcdf2143 4562
c44da964 4563** Minibuffer changes:
830047fd 4564
c44da964
RS
4565+++
4566*** The functions all-completions and try-completion now accept lists
4567of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
4568and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
4569exported to Lisp. The keys in alists and hash tables can be either
4570strings or symbols, which are automatically converted with to strings.
6c0b2643 4571
c44da964
RS
4572+++
4573*** The new macro `dynamic-completion-table' supports using functions
4574as a dynamic completion table.
8e8223e2 4575
c44da964 4576 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
8e8223e2 4577
c44da964
RS
4578FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
4579and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
4580completions. This alist can be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
4581can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
4582minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
4583entered. `dynamic-completion-table' then computes the completion.
30b0da81 4584
c44da964
RS
4585+++
4586*** The new macro `lazy-completion-table' initializes a variable
4587as a lazy completion table.
30b0da81 4588
c44da964 4589 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
30b0da81 4590
c44da964
RS
4591If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
4592as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
4593ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
4594completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
4595from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
4596`lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
30b0da81 4597
c44da964 4598** Lisp file loading changes:
406c0f12 4599
c44da964
RS
4600+++
4601*** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
4602which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
4603current file redefined it).
0df7a0b6 4604
51a8b435 4605+++
c44da964
RS
4606*** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
4607defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
8e8223e2 4608
51a8b435 4609+++
c44da964
RS
4610*** The function symbol-file can now search specifically for function or
4611variable definitions.
0ec6b206 4612
51a8b435 4613+++
c44da964
RS
4614*** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
4615to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
4616and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
30b0da81 4617
c44da964
RS
4618---
4619*** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
4620Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
4621than 3 levels of nesting.
7c3cb37d 4622
a7bd9dc7 4623+++
c44da964 4624** Byte compiler changes:
8e8223e2 4625
c44da964
RS
4626*** The byte-compiler now displays the actual line and character
4627position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form of its
4628warning and error messages have been brought more in line with the
4629output of other GNU tools.
202082d3 4630
c44da964
RS
4631*** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
4632inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
4633
4634*** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
4635simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
4636useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
4637Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
4638forms:
4639
4640 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
4641 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
4642
4643In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
4644won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
4645second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
4646unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
4647macro expansion), but such tests can be nested. Note that `when' and
4648`unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
4649
4650*** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
4651helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
4652Emacs and XEmacs and can sometimes make the result significantly more
4653efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
4654generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
4655you anything.
4656
4657*** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in elisp files is now obeyed.
4658
4659---
4660*** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
4661now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
4662(require 'cl) when loaded.
4663
4664** Frame operations:
63ca0a6e 4665
30b0da81 4666+++
c44da964 4667*** New functions `frame-current-scroll-bars' and `window-current-scroll-bars'.
30b0da81
RS
4668
4669These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
4670horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
30de4b24 4671
51a8b435 4672+++
c44da964
RS
4673*** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
4674for all (existing and future) frames.
30de4b24 4675
51a8b435 4676+++
c44da964
RS
4677*** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
4678for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
4679number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
4680Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
1c6576ab 4681
51a8b435 4682+++
c44da964
RS
4683*** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
4684the `scroll-bar-width' frame parameter value is nil.
026f408d 4685
c44da964 4686** Mule changes:
026f408d 4687
51a8b435 4688+++
c44da964 4689*** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
026f408d 4690
c44da964
RS
4691Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
4692from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
4693buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
4694now:
6c0b2643 4695
c44da964 46961. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
6c0b2643 4697
c44da964
RS
46982. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
4699the time it takes to convert the format.
6c0b2643 4700
c44da964
RS
47013. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
4702wasteful.
32ebbc3a 4703
c44da964
RS
4704---
4705*** set-buffer-file-coding-system now takes an additional argument,
4706NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
6c0b2643 4707
30b0da81 4708+++
c44da964
RS
4709*** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
4710to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
4711for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
4712file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
6c0b2643 4713
30b0da81 4714---
c44da964
RS
4715*** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
4716of one coding system from another coding system.
6c0b2643 4717
c44da964
RS
4718---
4719*** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
4720the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
4721parts, e.g. utf-16.
ace64e0a 4722
51a8b435 4723+++
c44da964
RS
4724*** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
4725it is read from a file without decoding.
123ac55e 4726
c44da964
RS
4727---
4728*** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
4729hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
0b559506 4730
c44da964
RS
4731---
4732*** New function quail-find-key returns a list of keys to type in the
4733current input method to input a character.
6b3daede 4734
c44da964 4735** Mode line changes:
c94472fc 4736
a775dff4 4737+++
c44da964 4738*** New function `format-mode-line'.
f24485f1 4739
c44da964
RS
4740This returns the mode-line or header-line of the selected (or a
4741specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
30de4b24 4742
f60a6f87 4743+++
c44da964
RS
4744*** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
4745used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
71c88486 4746
30b0da81 4747+++
c44da964
RS
4748*** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
4749to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
4750line.
30b0da81 4751
c44da964 4752** Menu manipulation changes:
30b0da81 4753
c44da964
RS
4754---
4755*** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
4756proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
4757"files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
4758several versions ago.
71c88486 4759
c44da964
RS
4760---
4761*** The dummy function keys made by easy-menu are now always lower case.
4762If you specify the menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
4763as the "key" bound by that key binding.
30de4b24 4764
c44da964
RS
4765This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for the bindings that were
4766made with easy-menu.
ffe5000a 4767
f60a6f87 4768---
c44da964
RS
4769*** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
4770if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
4771into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
4772need to have a name.
4773
4774** Operating system access:
c494f663 4775
85df292e 4776+++
c44da964
RS
4777*** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
4778run time used by Emacs since start-up.
4e3dd7cf 4779
c44da964
RS
4780+++
4781*** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
4782user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
4783accepts a float as UID parameter.
30b0da81 4784
c44da964
RS
4785+++
4786*** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
30b0da81 4787
c44da964
RS
4788---
4789*** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
4790The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
4791formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
30b0da81 4792
c44da964
RS
4793---
4794*** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
4795debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
4796
4797** Miscellaneous:
30b0da81
RS
4798
4799+++
c44da964 4800*** A number of hooks have been renamed to better follow the conventions:
30b0da81 4801
c44da964
RS
4802find-file-hooks to find-file-hook,
4803find-file-not-found-hooks to find-file-not-found-functions,
4804write-file-hooks to write-file-functions,
4805write-contents-hooks to write-contents-functions,
4806x-lost-selection-hooks to x-lost-selection-functions,
4807x-sent-selection-hooks to x-sent-selection-functions,
4808delete-frame-hook to delete-frame-functions.
30b0da81 4809
c44da964 4810In each case the old name remains as an alias for the moment.
30b0da81 4811
c44da964
RS
4812+++
4813*** local-write-file-hooks is marked obsolete
4814
4815Use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook'.
30b0da81
RS
4816
4817---
c44da964
RS
4818*** New function `x-send-client-message' sends a client message when
4819running under X.
6c0b2643 4820\f
71c88486
NR
4821* Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
4822
4823** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
4824been added.
4825
4826\f
4827* Changes in Emacs 21.3
4828
4829** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
4830with Custom.
4831
4832** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
2d2ff530 4833as mule-utf-8.
71c88486
NR
4834
4835** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
4836in UTF-8 locales).
4837
4838** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
4839different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
4840Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
4841and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
4842between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
4843(e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
4844`unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
4845`unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
4846it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
4847By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
4848
4849** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
4850`selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
4851
4852If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
4853compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
4854compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
4e07258f 4855text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
71c88486
NR
4856contrary to the compound text specification.
4857
4858\f
4859* Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
4860
4861** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
4862
4863** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
4864
4865\f
4866* Changes in Emacs 21.2
4867
4868** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
4869
4870X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
4871compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
4872list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
4873selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
4874compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
4875
4876** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
4877were changed.
4878
4879** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
4880now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
4881
4882** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
4883initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
4884instead of using default-major-mode.
4885
4886** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
4887like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
4888as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
4889(the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
4890visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
4891is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
4892to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
4893
4894This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
4895NEWS.
4896
4897\f
4898* Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
4899
4900** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
4901have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
4902and the latter now controls scrolling down.
4903
4904** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
4905be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
4906
4907\f
251584f3
DL
4908* Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
4909
889be0a1
DL
4910See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
4911fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
4912charsets in this release.
4913
f4988be7
GM
4914** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
4915
424d8b44
DL
4916** Support for LynxOS has been added.
4917
1fa28578 4918** There are new configure options associated with the support for
163ea954
RS
4919images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
4920to list them.
6344985d 4921
5ed8d5af 4922** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
60dd7e0e 4923support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
8628686a
DL
4924maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
4925build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
4926necessary changes to unexec.
f4988be7 4927
efeb796b
EZ
4928** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
4929Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
4930
4931** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
4932Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
4933
4934** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
4935the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
d9c9b920 4936
e90813b8 4937** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
a7c13351 4938all of the new display features described below. The port currently
d69aa2e3
EZ
4939lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
4940"Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
4941description of aspects specific to the Mac.
d9c9b920 4942
efeb796b
EZ
4943** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
4944new display features described below.
4945
05197f40 4946\f
1fa28578
GM
4947* Changes in Emacs 21.1
4948
1e7db2e9
GM
4949** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
4950
4951The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
4952Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
4953oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
4954of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
4955the text.
4956
4957** Emacs has a new face implementation.
4958
4959The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
4960font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
4961height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
4962These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
4963specify a font.
4964
4965Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
4966These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
4967under Lisp changes, below.
4968
4969** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
4970
4971Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
4972Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
4973the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
4974italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
4975Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
4976attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
4977on terminals.
4978
4979The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
4980supported on character terminals.
4981
efeb796b
EZ
4982Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
4983the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
4984same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
4985a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
4986
1e7db2e9
GM
4987** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
4988
efeb796b
EZ
4989** Sound support
4990
4991Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
4992driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
4993supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
c8682017
EZ
4994You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
4995sound support.
efeb796b 4996
1e7db2e9
GM
4997** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
4998
4999If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
5000longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
5001is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
5002minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
5003
5004- User option: max-mini-window-height
5005
5006Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
5007fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
5008specifies a number of lines.
5009
5010Default is 0.25.
5011
5012- User option: resize-mini-windows
5013
5014How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
5015resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
5016grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
5017again.
5018
5019Default is `grow-only'.
5020
5021** LessTif support.
5022
5023Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
a04c6760 5024<http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
1e7db2e9
GM
5025
5026** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
5027
5028When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
5029from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
5030non-nil.
5031
8f80abd8
EZ
5032** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
5033
5034When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
5035now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
5036file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
5037
1e7db2e9
GM
5038** Toolkit scroll bars.
5039
5040Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
5041LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
5042configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
5043bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
5044bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
5045Emacs.
5046
5047When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
5048Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
5049Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
5050Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
5051define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
5052`s/freebsd.h' as an example.
5053
5054Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
5055a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
5056directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
5057different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
5058system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
5059add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
5060
5061The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
5062`float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
5063This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
3593c177 5064imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
1e7db2e9
GM
5065Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
5066
1e7db2e9
GM
5067** Tool bar support.
5068
5069Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
5070of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
5071changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
5072displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
5073if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
5074icons will be used.
5075
5076To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
70fae708 5077for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
1e7db2e9 5078
1e7db2e9
GM
5079** Tooltips.
5080
5081Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
5082mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
5083turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
5084
5085Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
5086variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
5087the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
5088tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
5089
efeb796b
EZ
5090** Automatic Hscrolling
5091
5092Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
5093`automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
5094customized.
5095
5096If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
5097scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
5098for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
5099the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
5100to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
5101
1e7db2e9
GM
5102** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
5103of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
5104solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
ab9c49cf 5105`cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
1e7db2e9 5106cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
2018166d 5107non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
1e7db2e9
GM
5108
5109** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
5110truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
5111foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
5112customizing face `fringe'.
5113
5114** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
5115You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
5116In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
5117appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
5118occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
5119the window to be partially obscured.)
5120
5121The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
46ff99c0
MB
5122versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
5123However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
5124ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
1e7db2e9 5125
1e7db2e9
GM
5126** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
5127
6b9572dc
EZ
5128Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
5129systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
5130mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
5131mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
5132displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
5133have enabled one.
1e7db2e9
GM
5134
5135Currently, the following actions have been defined:
5136
3aa2f38a 5137- Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
1e7db2e9 5138
3aa2f38a 5139- Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
1e7db2e9
GM
5140
5141- Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
5142`*') toggles the status.
5143
5144- Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
5145
1e7db2e9
GM
5146** Hourglass pointer
5147
5148Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
5149turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
5150
1e7db2e9
GM
5151** Blinking cursor
5152
5153M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
5154terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
5155and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
5156the group `cursor'.
5157
1e7db2e9
GM
5158** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
5159
5160This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
5161generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
5162See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
5163details.
5164
5165Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
5166have to do anything to activate it.
5167
efeb796b
EZ
5168** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
5169
5170The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
5171determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
5172
5173On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
5174according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
5175key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
5176option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
5177delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
5178keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
5179keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
5180set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
5181
5182If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
5183a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
5184Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
5185`keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
5186the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
5187terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
5188
5189Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
5190to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
5191
1e7db2e9
GM
5192** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
5193changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
5194buffer by default.
5195
5196** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
5197current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
5198beginning and end of the buffer.
5199
5200** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
5201recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
5202signaled.
5203
5204** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
5205file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
5206
1e7db2e9
GM
5207** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
5208compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
5209this behavior.
5210
efeb796b 5211The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
1e7db2e9
GM
5212compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
5213Emacs dump core.
5214
5215** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
5216
5217When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
5218widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
5219Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
5220
5221** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
5222more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
5223now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
5224
5225** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
5226using that menu.
5227
1e7db2e9
GM
5228** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
5229
5230When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
5231whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
5232defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
5233highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
5234displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
5235whitespace.
5236
1e7db2e9
GM
5237** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
5238all frames except the selected one.
5239
5240** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
5241let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
5242
1e7db2e9
GM
5243** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
5244header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
5245so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
5246This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
5247`Info-use-header-line'.
5248
1e7db2e9
GM
5249** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
5250have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
5251`de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
5252
5253** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
5254
5255** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
5256`dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
5257`fr-drdref.tex'.
5258
1e7db2e9
GM
5259** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
5260displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
5261menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
5262menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
5263
efeb796b 5264** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
17851d9d 5265
a19e85cc 5266You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
17851d9d
EZ
5267because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
5268use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
5269`~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
1e7db2e9 5270
1e7db2e9
GM
5271** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
5272point in a pop-up window.
5273
1e7db2e9
GM
5274** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
5275under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
5276customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
5277
5278The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
5279determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
5280
1e7db2e9
GM
5281** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
5282sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
5283(On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
aa082854 5284You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
1e7db2e9 5285
1e7db2e9
GM
5286** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
5287
eb1b0c74
GM
5288** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
5289to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
5290
c607d53d 5291** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
346598f1 5292trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
c607d53d
SS
5293this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
5294
4104194e 5295** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
1e36ff68
DL
5296be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
5297non-nil.
4104194e 5298
ba9eeda1
GM
5299** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
5300set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
5301file that is already visited under a different name.
5302
42ac0ae5
GM
5303** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
5304nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
5305
ba9eeda1 5306** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
eb27839a 5307and displays information about that.
b941a14b 5308
25ad1371
GM
5309** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
5310expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
5311
5312This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
5313determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
5314mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
5315interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
5316regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
5317associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
5318
40e857ea 5319** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
424d8b44 5320suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
40e857ea 5321
c08398de
DL
5322** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
5323buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
5324contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
5325by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
5326insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
5327the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
5328Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
5329
efeb796b
EZ
5330** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
5331been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
5332
efeb796b
EZ
5333** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
5334system for keyboard input.
5335
3d6cd763
GM
5336** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
5337coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
5338escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
5339such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
5340recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
07b14857 5341always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
3d6cd763 5342read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
07b14857
KH
5343(`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
5344RET C-x C-f filename RET.
26ae8525 5345
0b8a3a6d
DL
5346** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
5347environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
5348
0b8a3a6d
DL
5349** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
5350displays all characters in that character set.
5351
5352** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
5353coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
5354
efeb796b
EZ
5355** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
5356and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
5357LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
5358
efeb796b
EZ
5359** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
5360Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
53618859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
5362GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
53638859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
5364There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
5365and Polish `slash'.
5366
efeb796b
EZ
5367** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
5368These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
5369of the tutorial.
5370
5371** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
5372function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
5373Lisp Coding Convention".
5374
5375 new command old-binding
5376 --- ------- -----------
5377 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
5378 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
5379 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
5380
5381 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
5382 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
5383 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
5384
5385 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
5386 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
5387 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
5388 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
5389 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
5390 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
5391
bd161121
EZ
5392** There are new Leim input methods.
5393New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
5394"greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
5395package.
5396
efeb796b
EZ
5397** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
5398rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
5399typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
5400"=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
5401"`", you must type "=q".
5402
efeb796b
EZ
5403** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
54048859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
5405more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
5406empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
5407window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
5408on.
5409
efeb796b
EZ
5410** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
5411on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
5412defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
5413commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
5cb6a58e 5414
5898e075
DL
5415** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
5416`display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
5417indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
5418indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
5419
cc181e95
GM
5420** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
5421on the display using several methods
5422
5423- By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
5424a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
5425be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
5426
5427- By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
5820dead 5428equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
cc181e95 5429
da4496b6 5430- By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
cc181e95
GM
5431
5432- By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
5433the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
5434
3b4fa1b2 5435** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
1c459486 5436an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
3b4fa1b2 5437command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
1c459486 5438does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
0daee095 5439
176256a1 5440** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
3bbc50af
DL
5441`make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
5442typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
176256a1 5443
dd0add8e
DL
5444** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
5445characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
5446
699238d9 5447** New X resources recognized
100b3cbb 5448
7233c5bd
GM
5449*** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
5450whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
5451is useful for debugging X problems.
5452
5453Example:
5454
699238d9 5455 emacs.synchronous: true
7233c5bd 5456
100b3cbb
GM
5457*** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
5458visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
5459the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
5460and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
5461visual class names are
5462
5463 TrueColor
5464 PseudoColor
5465 DirectColor
5466 StaticColor
5467 GrayScale
5468 StaticGray
5469
5470Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
5471`pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
5472meaning.
5473
5474The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
5475supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
5476`visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
5477visual.
5478
5479Example:
5480
699238d9 5481 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
100b3cbb
GM
5482
5483*** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
5484specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
5485default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
5486resource values are `true' or `on'.
5487
5488Example:
5489
699238d9 5490 emacs.privateColormap: true
100b3cbb 5491
a933dad1
DL
5492** Faces and frame parameters.
5493
5494There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
5495Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
5496`scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
5497`scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
5498sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
5499for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
5500parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
5501
5502Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
5503`default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
79214ddf 5504`foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
a933dad1
DL
5505`default' face and vice versa.
5506
f77a4a8a
GM
5507** New face `menu'.
5508
5509The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
f77a4a8a 5510
a933dad1
DL
5511** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
5512
5513The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
5514colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
5515correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
5516the screen gamma of a frame's display.
5517
5518PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
5519in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
5520color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
5521
5522The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
5523`ScreenGamma'.
5524
a933dad1
DL
5525** Tabs and variable-width text.
5526
5527Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
5528defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
5529independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
5530Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
5531
5532** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
5533
5534*** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
5535
5536 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
5537
79dd1637
RS
5538The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
5539LessTif/Motif one.
a933dad1 5540
79dd1637
RS
5541*** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
5542LessTif and Motif.
a933dad1 5543
a933dad1
DL
5544** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
5545
5546As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
5547drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
5548`x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
5549
5550** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
efeb796b 5551bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
a933dad1
DL
5552
5553This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
5554`indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
5555variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
5556
5557** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
5558
5559When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
d9e66103 5560value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
a933dad1 5561number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
d5951185 5562fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
a933dad1
DL
5563
5564When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
8a33023e 5565value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
a933dad1 5566number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
d5951185 5567fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
a933dad1 5568
efeb796b
EZ
5569** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
5570M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
5571M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
5572buffers.
5573
5574** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
5575
5576** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
5577abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
5578`directory-abbrev-alist'.
5579
efeb796b
EZ
5580** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
5581the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
5582forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
5583value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
5584users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
5585even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
5586
5587The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
5588
a933dad1
DL
5589** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
5590notably at the end of lines.
5591
5592All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
5593spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
5594
8748ecc0 5595** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
eee54b0e 5596
8748ecc0
GM
5597** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
5598but inserts text instead of replacing it.
2ce72bfa 5599
a933dad1
DL
5600** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
5601query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
5602after each match to get the replacement text.
5603
d5483ab1
GM
5604** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
5605you edit the replacement string.
4ff40dd0 5606
75823f67
EZ
5607** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
5608(if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
5609in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
4ff40dd0 5610
efeb796b 5611** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
889be0a1 5612
efeb796b
EZ
5613** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
5614to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
327652be 5615
efeb796b
EZ
5616** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
5617the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
5618MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
5619displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
a32da22c 5620
75823f67 5621--
efeb796b
EZ
5622** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
5623read mail from the menu etc.
559cee90 5624
efeb796b
EZ
5625** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
5626This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
5627MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
5628before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
559cee90 5629
efeb796b
EZ
5630** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
5631MS-DOS version of Emacs.
424d8b44 5632
efeb796b
EZ
5633** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
5634of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
5635This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
5636correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
5637but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
5638of Emacs.
eb2aac9d 5639
efeb796b 5640** Customize changes
eb2aac9d 5641
efeb796b
EZ
5642*** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
5643`State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
5644M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
5645customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
5646earlier versions of Emacs.
1b24b888 5647
efeb796b
EZ
5648*** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
5649Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
5650default).
79c78e77 5651
efeb796b
EZ
5652*** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5653does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
5654file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
5655wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
5656file.
79c78e77 5657
7e97c157
EZ
5658** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5659does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
5660avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
5661already in your init file.
5662
efeb796b 5663** New features in evaluation commands
3476b54a 5664
efeb796b
EZ
5665*** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
5666modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
5667print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
5668customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
5669eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
a933dad1 5670
f37e8c77
EZ
5671The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
5672respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
5673the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
5674the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
5675printed).
5676
75c5350a
GM
5677<RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
5678printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
f6e6cdf2 5679
f37e8c77
EZ
5680The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
5681during evaluation produces a backtrace.
5682
3a426197 5683*** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
5e03eb84
GM
5684code when called with a prefix argument.
5685
b1c609b1
GM
5686** CC mode changes.
5687
5688Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
5689current user setups (although it's believed that these
5690incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
5691However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
5692back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
5693compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
5694release.
5695
e120bebf
GM
5696*** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
5697CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
5698is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
5699confusion.
5700
5701However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
5702default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
5703java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
5704notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
5705
5706*** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
5707Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
5708
5709space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
5710parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
5711
5712compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
5713parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
5714It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
5715style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
5716
5717*** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
5718Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
5719"electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
5720earlier statement. An example:
5721
5722for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
5723 if (a[i])
5724 res += a[i]->offset;
5725else
5726
5727Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
5728continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
5729the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
5730possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
5731the preceding "if".
5732
5733CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
5734by default.
5735
5736*** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
5737Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
5738meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
5739documentation or other natural language text.
5740
5741The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
5742contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
5743the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
5744strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
5745to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
5746commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
5747sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
5748
5749*** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
5750Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
5751source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
5752comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
5753
5754*** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
5755When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
5756line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
5757change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
5758Pike mode only.
5759
5760*** Better handling of syntactic errors.
5761The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
5762improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
5763stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
5764following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
5765matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
5766indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
5767is reported afterwards.
5768
5769*** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
5770A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
5771returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
5772
5773*** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
5774Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
5775on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
5776can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
5777code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
5778modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
5779groundwork.
5780
7972fcfc
GM
5781*** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
5782This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
5783of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
5784non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
5785want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
5786have to bother.
5787
5788Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
5789situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
487522fe 5790and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
7972fcfc
GM
5791If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
5792the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
5793by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
5794
b1c609b1
GM
5795*** New initialization procedure for the style system.
5796When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
5797variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
5798take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
5799is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
5800settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
5801possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
5802Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
5803
5804By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
5805special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
5806the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
5807of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
5808above.
5809
5810Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
5811when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
5812function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
5813call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
5814then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
5815values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
5816only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
5817function documentation for more info.
5818
5819The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
5820especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
5821with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
5822intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
5823such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
5824is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
5825configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
5826global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
5827
5828(Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
5829
5830**** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
5831This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
5832
5833This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
5834variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
5835completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
5836the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
5837empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
5838style system.
5839
5840**** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
5841In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
5842c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
5843as far as possible.
5844
5845*** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
5846CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
5847surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
5848chapter about this in the manual.
5849
5850**** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
5851The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
5852recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
5853primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
5854adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
5855
5856**** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
5857This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
5858c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
5859
5860**** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
5861This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
5862
5863It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
5864Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
5865A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
5866inside CC Mode.
5867
5868Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
5869causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
5870the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
5871available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
5872cc-mode/).
5873
9ed462b7
EZ
5874**** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
5875`c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
5876enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
5877function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
5878they were before the filling.
5879
b1c609b1
GM
5880**** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
5881The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
5882specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
5883literals.
5884
5885**** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
5886It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
5887prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
5888you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
5889this function.
5890
5891*** Fixes to IDL mode.
5892It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
5893to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
5894struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
5895Thanks to Eric Eide.
5896
5897*** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
5898It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
5899opening braces hangs and when they don't.
5900
5901**** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
5902
5903*** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
5904See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
5905better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
5906and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
5907
5908*** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
5909previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
5910the column specified by comment-column.
5911
5912*** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
5913In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
5914is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
5915prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
5916contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
5917don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
5918
5919*** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
5920instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
5921arguments.
5922
5923*** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
5924
5925*** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
5926c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
5927c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
5928variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
5929Provan).
5930
5931*** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
5932
efeb796b 5933** Dired changes
c407c570 5934
efeb796b
EZ
5935*** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
5936command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
5937is, delete only empty directories.
c407c570 5938
efeb796b
EZ
5939*** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
5940command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
5941copy directories recursively.
87be76f6 5942
efeb796b
EZ
5943*** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
5944in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
5945the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
3353ef5a 5946
efeb796b
EZ
5947*** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
5948replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
5949directory.
c407c570 5950
a320a8e7 5951*** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
efeb796b
EZ
5952a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
5953This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
5954will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
5955accurate or inaccurate as it is.
5956
5957*** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
5958from ls switches.
5959
5960*** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
5961of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
5962which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
5963source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
a933dad1 5964
efeb796b 5965** Gnus changes.
87be76f6 5966
efeb796b
EZ
5967The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
5968four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
5969internationalization and mail-fetching.
87be76f6 5970
efeb796b
EZ
5971*** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
5972many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
87be76f6 5973
efeb796b 5974If you used procmail like in
87be76f6 5975
efeb796b
EZ
5976(setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
5977(setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
5978(setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
5979(setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
35384f06 5980
efeb796b 5981this now has changed to
87be76f6 5982
efeb796b
EZ
5983(setq mail-sources
5984 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
5985 :suffix ".in")))
d7b511c4 5986
efeb796b
EZ
5987More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
5988Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
d67f47e4 5989
efeb796b
EZ
5990*** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
5991Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
5992Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
5993longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
d7b511c4 5994
efeb796b
EZ
5995The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
5996use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
5997installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
9d453139 5998
efeb796b
EZ
5999*** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
6000parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
6001are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
6002now just a compatibility layer.
4b9347b3 6003
75823f67
EZ
6004*** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
6005Gnus facilities.
6006
efeb796b
EZ
6007*** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
6008called to position point.
4b9347b3 6009
efeb796b
EZ
6010*** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
6011summary buffers and NOV files.
79214ddf 6012
efeb796b
EZ
6013*** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
6014of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
79214ddf 6015
efeb796b
EZ
6016*** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
6017subtly different manner.
aca0be23 6018
efeb796b
EZ
6019*** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
6020and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
6021ever-changing layouts.
79214ddf 6022
efeb796b 6023*** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
79214ddf 6024
efeb796b 6025*** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
8c463abe 6026
efeb796b 6027** Changes in Texinfo mode.
8c463abe 6028
efeb796b
EZ
6029*** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
6030macros
79214ddf 6031
efeb796b
EZ
6032 Key binding Macro
6033 -------------------------
6034 C-c C-c C-s @strong
6035 C-c C-c C-e @emph
6036 C-c C-c u @uref
6037 C-c C-c q @quotation
6038 C-c C-c m @email
6039 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
6040 M-RET @item
79214ddf 6041
efeb796b 6042*** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
79214ddf 6043
efeb796b 6044** Changes in Outline mode.
79214ddf 6045
efeb796b
EZ
6046There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
6047`outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
6048the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
89d57763 6049
efeb796b 6050** Changes to Emacs Server
79214ddf 6051
efeb796b
EZ
6052*** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
6053with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
6054are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
6055Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
6056buffers to kill, as before.
79214ddf 6057
efeb796b
EZ
6058Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
6059i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
6060this way.
6061
6062** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
6063of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
6064
6065** Changes to Show Paren mode.
6066
6067*** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
6068The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
6069use. Default is 1000.
79214ddf 6070
efeb796b
EZ
6071** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
6072groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
f6737cde 6073
efeb796b 6074** Changes to hideshow.el
3f6e4b8b 6075
efeb796b 6076*** Generalized block selection and traversal
f6737cde 6077
efeb796b
EZ
6078A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
6079and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
6080serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
6081See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
f6737cde 6082
efeb796b
EZ
6083*** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
6084hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
6085be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
6086the open block.
f6737cde 6087
efeb796b
EZ
6088*** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
6089function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
6090the normal block-hiding function.
f6737cde 6091
efeb796b 6092*** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
f6737cde 6093
efeb796b
EZ
6094*** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
6095roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
6096for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
6097for `hs-minor-mode'.
f6737cde 6098
efeb796b
EZ
6099*** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
6100hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
f6737cde 6101
efeb796b 6102** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
f6737cde 6103
efeb796b
EZ
6104*** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
6105an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
6106log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
0c68ce6f 6107
efeb796b
EZ
6108**** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
6109current buffer.
d521e087 6110
efeb796b
EZ
6111*** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
6112in a log file.
1e7db2e9 6113
efeb796b
EZ
6114*** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
6115entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
6116Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
6117version number is performed based on regular expressions from
6118`change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
6119Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
6120
6121*** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
6122
6123** Changes to cmuscheme
6124
6125*** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
6126`cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
6127
6128** Changes in Font Lock
6129
6130*** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
6131font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
6132
6133*** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
6134set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
6135
6136*** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
6137the face used for each string/comment.
6138
6139*** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
6140Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
6141
6142** Changes to Shell mode
6143
6144*** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
6145to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
6146non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
6147prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
6148
6149** Comint (subshell) changes
6150
6151These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
6152include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
6153
6154*** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
6155Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
6156BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
6157beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
6158respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
6159the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
6160
6161*** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
6162to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
6163parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
6164user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
6165this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
6166respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
6167feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
6168`comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
6169
6170*** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
6171and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
6172
6173*** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
6174buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
6175buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
6176
6177The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
6178M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
6179the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
6180
6181*** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
6182and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
6183see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
6184
6185*** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
6186saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
6187argument, it appends to the file.
6188
6189*** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
6190(usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
6191compatibility.
6192
6193*** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
6194ring (history).
6195
6196*** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
6197identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
6198strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
6199
6200** Changes to Rmail mode
6201
6202*** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
6203set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
6204receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
6205recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
6206`user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
6207as correspondent.
6208
6209Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
6210mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
6211regexp matching your mail addresses.
6212
6213*** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
6214to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
6215Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
6216with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
6217for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
6218
6219*** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
6220like `j'.
6221
6222*** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
6223specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
6224digest message.
6225
6226*** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
6227in which folder to put messages automatically.
6228
6229*** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
6230with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
6231due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
6232
6233** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
6234an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
6235
75823f67
EZ
6236** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
6237use the -f option when sending mail.
6238
f68113db
EZ
6239** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
6240current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
6241the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
6242This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
6243by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
6244displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
6245
6246If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
6247other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
6248`rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
6249
efeb796b
EZ
6250** Changes to TeX mode
6251
6252*** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
6253`latex-mode'.
6254
6255*** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
6256
6257*** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
6258
6259*** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
6260
6261** Changes to RefTeX mode
6262
6263*** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
6264 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
6265 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
6266 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
6267 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
6268 can be edited from that buffer.
6269
6270*** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
6271 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
6272 `A' to use all marked entries).
6273
6274*** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
6275 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
6276
6277*** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
6278 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
6279 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
6280 been cited.
6281
6282** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
6283The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
6284semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
6285in column 1 are always made leaves.
6286
6287** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
6288has the following new features:
6289
6290*** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
6291may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
6292to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
6293time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
6294
6295*** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
6296feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
6297file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
6298compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
6299pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
6300defaults to 1.
6301
6302** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
6303file names.
6304
6305** Ispell changes
fbc164de 6306
efeb796b
EZ
6307*** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
6308transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
6309spell-checks the current buffer.
59c1bf85 6310
efeb796b
EZ
6311*** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
6312added.
732b9cdd 6313
efeb796b
EZ
6314*** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
6315correction is made and re-checked.
b8b2ea31 6316
4cdf4bde 6317*** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
b8b2ea31 6318
efeb796b
EZ
6319*** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
6320cases.
b8b2ea31 6321
efeb796b
EZ
6322*** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
6323on syntax errors.
6324
6325*** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
6326end of the buffer.
6327
6328*** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6329
efeb796b
EZ
6330** Makefile mode changes
6331
6332*** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
b8b2ea31 6333
efeb796b
EZ
6334*** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
6335Fontlock mode is active.
1e406be0 6336
efeb796b 6337** Isearch changes
e33b0397 6338
efeb796b
EZ
6339*** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
6340so that searches can be resumed.
e33b0397 6341
3a426197 6342*** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
efeb796b
EZ
6343respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
6344that started the search.
6345
6346*** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
6347selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
6f8ea2ae 6348
efeb796b 6349*** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
c0510d27 6350
efeb796b
EZ
6351Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
6352`isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
6353search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
6354before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
6355highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
6356`secondary-selection'.
5d94f558 6357
efeb796b
EZ
6358The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
6359will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
6360Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
6361using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
6362usual snappy response.
dc28878c 6363
efeb796b
EZ
6364If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
6365matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
6366set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
6367isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
95931eb1 6368
54baed30
GM
6369** VC Changes
6370
6371VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
6372easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
6373Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
6374to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
6375changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
60a441a5 6376`vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
54baed30
GM
6377version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
6378each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
6379file is registered in that backend.
6380
6381When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
6382backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
6383directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
6384master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
6385the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
6386As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
6387
6388The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
6389still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
6390RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
6391vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
6392where it doesn't make sense.)
6393
6394The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
6395obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
6396`CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
6397
6398*** General Changes
6399
6400The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
6401checks are always done now.
6402
327652be 6403VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
54baed30
GM
6404operations.
6405
c286608e
SM
6406`vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
6407`vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
6408`vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
6409
22933be8
AS
6410The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
6411first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
6412current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
6413the working file (``merge news'').
6414
6415The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6416(vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
6417downwards.
6418
6419*** Multiple Backends
6420
6421VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
6422useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
6423repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
6424commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
6425local RCS archives.
6426
6427To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
6428should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
6429backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
6430`vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
6431
60a441a5
AS
6432You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
6433C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
6434a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
6435if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
6436current revision number from the more remote backend.
22933be8
AS
6437
6438If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
6439another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
6440any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
6441pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
6442
6443After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
6444changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
6445local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
6446buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
6447
54baed30
GM
6448*** Changes for CVS
6449
6450There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
6451default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
6452remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
6453by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
6454regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
6455that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
6456queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
6457
22933be8
AS
6458If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
6459repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
6460revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
6461any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
6462backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
6463number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
6464(vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
6465of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
6466the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
105602b1
EZ
6467automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
6468since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
6469name.)
22933be8 6470
54baed30
GM
6471If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
6472repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
6473If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
22933be8 6474commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
54baed30
GM
6475current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
6476entire directory tree.
6477
6478The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
6479"cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
6480is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
6481"watched" by other developers.)
6482
22933be8
AS
6483The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6484(vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
60a441a5 6485an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
22933be8
AS
6486starting at the given directory.
6487
54baed30
GM
6488*** Lisp Changes in VC
6489
6490VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
6491add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
6492library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
6493then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
60a441a5
AS
6494a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
6495provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
54baed30 6496of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
60a441a5
AS
6497you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
6498`SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
54baed30 6499
c4ed232b 6500** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
732b9cdd
GM
6501SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
6502terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
6503See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
6504
a933dad1
DL
6505** New modes and packages
6506
79b9f6e0
MB
6507*** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
6508automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
6509the default is not applicable.
6510
b95b34e5
GM
6511*** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
6512rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
6513shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
6514
6515Features are:
6516
6517- Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
6518 drawn, like this: | \ /
c607d53d 6519 --+-- X
b95b34e5
GM
6520 | / \
6521
6522- Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
6523 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
6524 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
6525 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
6526 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
6527 you are drawing.
6528
6529- Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
6530 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
6531
6532- Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
6533 flood-filling.
6534
6535- Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
6536 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
6537 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
6538 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
c607d53d 6539
b95b34e5
GM
6540- Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
6541 also do without the mouse.
6542
6543- Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
6544 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
6545 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
6546 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
6547 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
6548
6549- Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
6550
6551 lines straight-lines
6552 rectangles squares
6553 poly-lines straight poly-lines
6554 ellipses circles
6555 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
6556 spray-can setting size for spraying
6557 vaporize line vaporize lines
6558 erase characters erase rectangles
6559
6560 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
6561 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
6562 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
6563 drawing.
6564
6565 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
6566 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
6567 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
6568 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
6569
6570- Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
6571 can be turned off).
6572
4473cdd9
JW
6573*** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
6574implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
6575It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
6576functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
6577history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
6578will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
6579the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
6580rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
6581all within the scope of your Emacs process.
6582
90cbf47e
GM
6583*** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
6584intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
6585typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
6586on certain projects.
6587
baf7eee4
GM
6588*** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
6589of interactively entered regexps. For example,
abb2db1c 6590
d96d6bb0 6591 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
abb2db1c
GM
6592
6593will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
6594face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
6595typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
6596Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
6597appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
6598current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
baf7eee4
GM
6599corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
6600to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
abb2db1c 6601
d96d6bb0 6602*** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
abb2db1c
GM
6603Emacs is idle.
6604
b4c3513f
EZ
6605*** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
6606fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
6607
31fc5d15
GM
6608*** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
6609parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
6610
5cb6a58e
SM
6611*** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
6612package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
6613be more robust while offering the same functionality.
601e0081
SM
6614`comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
6615comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
5cb6a58e 6616
578979ee
GM
6617*** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
6618facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
6619separate Texinfo file.
6620
424d8b44
DL
6621*** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
6622by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
6623provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
6624`log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
8a33023e 6625enter check-in log messages.
dc1178bf 6626
6abca616
EZ
6627*** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
6628without invoking external programs.
6629
6630The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
6631and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
6632`manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
6633is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
490f2e7b 6634Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
6abca616
EZ
6635
6636The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
6637page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
6638
5e5dff44
GM
6639*** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
6640authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
6641
6642The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
6643the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
6644the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
6645Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
6646even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
6647single step.
6648
6649On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
6650matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
6651probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
6652contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
6653
f7136ee8
GM
6654*** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
6655unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
6656actually modifying content of a buffer.
6657
bbd9b566
GM
6658*** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
6659PostScript.
6660
6661Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
6662
6663The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
6664
6665 ; comment (until end of line)
6666 A non-terminal
6667 "C" terminal
6668 ?C? special
6669 $A default non-terminal
6670 $"C" default terminal
6671 $?C? default special
6672 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
6673 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
6674 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
6675 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
6676 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
6677 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
6678 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
6679 C+ one or more occurrences of C
6680 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
6681 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
6682 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
6683 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
6684 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
6685 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6686 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6687
6688Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
6689
99453a38
GM
6690*** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
6691align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
6692determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
6693example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
6694equal signs of assignments.
6695
559cee90
DL
6696*** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
6697paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
6698
6448a6b3
GM
6699*** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
6700list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
2018166d 6701buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
6448a6b3 6702
6344985d
GM
6703*** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
6704
249652b1
GM
6705*** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
6706replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
6707is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
6708and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
6709not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
6710which answers different needs.
6711
3476b54a
GM
6712*** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
6713suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
6714expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
6715course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
6716reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
6717to be enabled.
6718
8964fec7
SM
6719*** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
6720containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
6721
a933dad1
DL
6722*** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
6723
16837afc
GM
6724*** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
6725current line in the current buffer. It also provides
dfd67a62 6726`global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
a933dad1
DL
6727
6728*** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
6729
fba448c1 6730Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
8901d1ac
GM
6731`global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
6732disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
6733`comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
6734displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
6735and background colors.
6736
a933dad1
DL
6737*** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
6738Pascal) language.
6739
6740*** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
6741the text at point.
6742
6743*** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
6744
8d54eb69
DL
6745*** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
6746
732b9cdd
GM
6747*** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
6748whitespace in a file.
a933dad1 6749
ebcfda83
GM
6750*** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
6751files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
6752(very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
6753interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
6754often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
6755uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
6756codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
6757
6758*** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
6759
6760Here is an example of columns:
6761
6762horse apple bus
6763dog pineapple car EXTRA
6764porcupine strawberry airplane
6765
6766Doing the following settings:
6767
6768 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
6769 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
6770 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
6771 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
6772
6773
6774Selecting the lines above and typing:
6775
6776 M-x delimit-columns-region
6777
6778It results:
6779
6780[ horse , apple , bus , ]
6781[ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
6782[ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
6783
6784delim-col has the following options:
6785
6786 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
6787 before all columns.
6788
6789 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
6790 between each column.
6791
6792 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
6793 after all columns.
6794
6795 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
6796 each column.
6797
6798delim-col has the following commands:
6799
6800 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
6801 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
6802
2018166d
DL
6803*** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
6804operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
6805menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
6806recent file list can be displayed:
f507826c 6807
31fc5d15 6808- organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
8a33023e
GM
6809- sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
6810- showing paths relative to the current default-directory
f507826c 6811
31fc5d15
GM
6812The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
6813dynamically change the menu appearance.
f507826c 6814
8062f458
DL
6815*** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
6816text.
6817
36e24b82 6818*** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
91735437
DL
6819of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
6820specific to Message mode.
6821
36e24b82
DL
6822*** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
6823viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
6824with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
6825
aaa659ef
DL
6826*** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
6827interface to access directory servers using different directory
6828protocols. It has a separate manual.
6829
eee54b0e
DL
6830*** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
6831for Autoconf, selected automatically.
6832
612839b6
GM
6833*** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
6834
5d94f558 6835*** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
612839b6 6836minibuffer with completion.
aaa659ef 6837
399da7e3
DL
6838*** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
6839with the diary features.
6840
6e417ca5
DL
6841*** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
6842numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
6843
4a27bdfb
GM
6844*** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
6845Fill mode.
6846
dace60cf
JW
6847*** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
6848facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
6849difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
6850they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
a18a342d 6851
9540ec3f
EZ
6852*** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
6853It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
6854`.g'.
6855
efeb796b
EZ
6856** Changes in sort.el
6857
6858The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
6859as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
6860new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
6861numeric base.
6862
6863** Changes to Ange-ftp
6864
efeb796b
EZ
6865*** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
6866names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
6867sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
6868
6869*** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
6870ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
6871
6872*** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
6873output ^M at the end of lines.
6874
efeb796b
EZ
6875** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
6876mode `iswitchb-mode'.
6877
efeb796b
EZ
6878** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
6879If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
6880`(msb-mode 1)'.
6881
6882** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
6883group.
6884
6885** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
6886behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
6887are recognized:
6888
6889`untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
6890`hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
6891`all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
6892nil -- just delete one character.
6893
6894Default value is `untabify'.
6895
6896[This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
6897
6898** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
6899symbol, not double-quoted.
6900
6901** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
6902version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
6903profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
6904moved to lisp/obsolete.
6905
6906** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
6907To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
6908`auto-compression-mode' command.
6909
6910** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
6911`browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
6912`browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
6913
6914** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
6915`browse-url-new-window-flag'.
6916
efeb796b
EZ
6917** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
6918operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
6919
efeb796b
EZ
6920** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
6921is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
6922
6923** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
6924support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
6925use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
6926buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
6927M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
6928new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
6929
efeb796b
EZ
6930** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
6931a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
6932
6933** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
6934
6935The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
6936file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
6937
6938** Shell script mode changes.
6939
6940Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
6941derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
6942sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
6943
6944** Etags changes.
6945
6946*** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
6947
6948*** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
6949possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
6950{lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
6951This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
6952a regular expression. The manual contains details.
6953
6954*** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
6955declarations when given the --declarations option.
6956
6957*** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
6958"operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
6959
6960*** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
6961automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
6962`template' keywords.
6963
6964*** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
6965C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
6966
6967*** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
6968types.
6969
6970*** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
6971
6972*** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
6973
6974*** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
6975are now tagged.
6976
6977*** In makefiles, tags the targets.
6978
6979*** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
6980variables are tagged.
6981
6982*** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
6983
6984*** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
6985for PSWrap.
6986
efeb796b
EZ
6987** Changes in etags.el
6988
6989*** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
6990tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
6991is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
6992
6993*** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
6994the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
6995
6996If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
6997FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
6998TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
6999obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
7000
7001TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
7002
7003FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
7004List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
7005
7006A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
7007
7008 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
7009 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
7010 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
7011
7012*** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
7013of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
7014
7015*** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
7016names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
7017
7018*** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
7019If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
7020/tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
7021"dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
7022point will go to the beginning of the file.
7023
7024*** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
7025auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
7026(with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
7027
7028*** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
7029in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
7030found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
7031
efeb796b
EZ
7032** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
7033remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
7034appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
7035
7036** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
7037
efeb796b
EZ
7038** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
7039
efeb796b
EZ
7040** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
7041containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
7042expression from that list, are not checked.
7043
7044** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
7045When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
7046and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
7047the buffer, just like for the local files.
7048
7049** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
7050
efeb796b
EZ
7051** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
7052displays local abbrevs, only.
7053
965bc065
DL
7054** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
7055paragraphs filled as you modify them.
7056
4e8864c7
GM
7057** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
7058may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
7059is measured in pixels.
7060
965bc065
DL
7061** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
7062to be visited as images.
7063
68d0efa6
GM
7064** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
7065were added to compile.el.
7066
a933dad1
DL
7067** Withdrawn packages
7068
7069*** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
7070functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
25a81338 7071
3261c1d8
DL
7072*** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
7073
7074*** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
ce75fd23 7075
05197f40 7076\f
01242779
DL
7077* Incompatible Lisp changes
7078
7079There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
7080may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
3b6936cc 7081See the sections below for details.
01242779 7082
89d57763 7083** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
9b2a085d 7084`(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
bd1190d7
RS
7085Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
7086to remove the properties of the copy.
01242779
DL
7087
7088** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
7089which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
7090may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
7091these properties are active.
7092
4dd4cc14 7093** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
01242779 7094ranges may affect some code.
1c14ba45
DL
7095
7096** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
7097buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
7098make a difference to some code.
7099
4dd4cc14
DL
7100** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
7101operates on the minibuffer.
7102
7c94ccf6
EZ
7103** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7104cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
7105different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
7106(previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
7107Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
7108character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
7109multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
7110encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
7111reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
7112sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
7113a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
7114the buffer as multibyte characters.
7115
7116Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
7117MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
7118appropriate for reading truly binary files.
7119
7a39158f 7120** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
3280fbe8
EZ
7121`after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
7122`before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
7a39158f
DL
7123
7124** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
539e74f9
EZ
7125long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
7126such as `mapconcat'.
7a39158f 7127
55bb62fd
EZ
7128** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
7129string.
7130
f34eb373
DL
7131** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
7132extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
7133dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
7134one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
7135charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
7136the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
028d739a
DL
7137encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
7138probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
3478eafc 7139
98384b7b
EZ
7140** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
7141Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
7142aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
7143not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
7144on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
7145behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
7146turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
7147remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
7148advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
7149will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
7cd5f1e7 7150
05197f40 7151\f
ce75fd23
GM
7152* Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
7153(Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
7154
e3b22517
GM
7155** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
7156
1ff74324 7157** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
9e5a7f2a
GM
7158allows the animated display of strings.
7159
ed31fabf
GM
7160** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
7161interactive form of a function.
7162
2018166d
DL
7163** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
7164between custom options. Example:
7165
7166 (defcustom default-input-method nil
7167 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
7168 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
7169 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
7170 :group 'mule
7171 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
7172 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
7173
7174This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
7175current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
7176first in a custom-set-variables statement.
7177
f3780fe4 7178** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
a758f97d
GM
7179function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
7180args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
7181(signal or normal termination).
7182
023045d6
DL
7183** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
7184from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
7185
eb1b0c74
GM
7186** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
7187to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
7188
52d89894
GM
7189** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
7190alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
7191
693c4692 7192** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
4301cf66 7193
6bc92b2e
GM
7194** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
7195deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
7196being deleted.
7197
39e776cd
SM
7198** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
7199
1396138a 7200** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
a18a342d
DL
7201If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
7202skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
7203with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
7204C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
7205charset.
7206
4fbdfdcf
MB
7207** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
7208the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
7209message.
7210
6a0b0752
MB
7211** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
7212expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
7213
47e351a3
GM
7214** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
7215with the more general `:mask' property.
7216
f864120f 7217** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
ba9eeda1 7218
a2bd77b8
GM
7219** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
7220backslash.
7221
424d8b44
DL
7222** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
7223is running in batch mode. For example,
7224
7225 (message "%s" (read t))
7226
7227will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
7228to standard output.
7229
424d8b44
DL
7230** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
7231`kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
7232
ead53494
GM
7233** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
7234will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
7235frame or window.
7236
27848c01
GM
7237** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
7238were added
7239
7240- Function: remove ELT SEQ
7241
8a33023e 7242Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
27848c01
GM
7243a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
7244
7245- Function: remq ELT LIST
7246
8a33023e 7247Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
27848c01
GM
7248comparison is done with `eq'.
7249
7250** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
3ab82477 7251
b548072f 7252** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
c8682017 7253has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
92d2f186 7254`key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
b548072f 7255
07b14857
KH
7256** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
7257without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
7258convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
7259
9662da0b
GM
7260** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
7261or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
d5aa31d8 7262
7fce7efb
DL
7263** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
7264function was declared obsolete.
7265
5d94f558 7266** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
7fce7efb
DL
7267retained as an alias).
7268
593b3517
RS
7269** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
7270the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
f98d3086 7271
87efd256
GM
7272** The new function `window-list' has been defined
7273
39b39373
GM
7274- Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
7275
7276Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
7277omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
7278the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
7279even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
7280minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
7281means never include the minibuffer window.
87efd256 7282
a56ebb90 7283** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
67c9a1d2 7284
a56ebb90 7285- Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
67c9a1d2
GM
7286
7287Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
7288
7289This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
7290calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
7291argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
7292value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
7293returned.
7294
7295Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
7296if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
7297it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
7298minibuffer even if it is active.
7299
7300Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
7301counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
7302too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
7303and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
7304`walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
7305entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
7306
7307ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
7308ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
7309ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
7310ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
7311ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
7312If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
7313Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
7314
ead53494
GM
7315** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
7316event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
7317argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
dce6b995 7318
25fa6deb
GM
7319** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
7320call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
088831a6
GM
7321message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
7322Default value is nil.
25fa6deb 7323
5d94f558 7324** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
1681ead6
GM
7325meaning no limit.
7326
5b034b7f
EZ
7327** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
7328the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
7329numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
7330
5d94f558 7331** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
c08398de
DL
7332coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
7333DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
7334
9b2999d0
DL
7335** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
7336list of a primitive.
de370c4c 7337
c286608e
SM
7338** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
7339
80c05bd3
DL
7340** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
7341buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
7342This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
7343than replacing the local map.
7344
14fd0da3
DL
7345** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
7346`after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
7347removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
7348instead.
45f485a6
GM
7349
7350** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
7351
c286608e
SM
7352** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
7353as promised long ago.
f0298744 7354
5d94f558 7355** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
ac57988b
GM
7356
7357** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
7358for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
7359patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
7360
05197f40 7361\f
a933dad1
DL
7362* Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
7363
6260538e
GM
7364** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
7365regular expressions.
7366
7367- Function: rx-to-string SEXP
7368
7369Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7370
7371- Macro: rx SEXP
7372
7373Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7374
7375The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
7376notation.
7377
7378STRING
7379 matches string STRING literally.
7380
7381CHAR
7382 matches character CHAR literally.
7383
7384`not-newline'
7385 matches any character except a newline.
7386 .
7387`anything'
7388 matches any character
7389
7390`(any SET)'
7391 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
7392 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
7393
79014980 7394'(in SET)'
6260538e
GM
7395 like `any'.
7396
7397`(not (any SET))'
7398 matches any character not in SET
7399
7400`line-start'
7401 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
7402 in the text being matched
7403
7404`line-end'
7405 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
7406
7407`string-start'
7408 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7409 string being matched against.
7410
7411`string-end'
7412 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7413 string being matched against.
7414
7415`buffer-start'
7416 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7417 buffer being matched against.
7418
7419`buffer-end'
7420 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7421 buffer being matched against.
7422
7423`point'
7424 matches the empty string, but only at point.
7425
7426`word-start'
7427 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7428 word.
7429
7430`word-end'
7431 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
7432
7433`word-boundary'
7434 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7435 word.
7436
7437`(not word-boundary)'
7438 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
7439 word.
7440
7441`digit'
7442 matches 0 through 9.
7443
7444`control'
7445 matches ASCII control characters.
7446
7447`hex-digit'
7448 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7449
7450`blank'
7451 matches space and tab only.
7452
7453`graphic'
7454 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7455 space, and DEL.
7456
7457`printing'
7458 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7459 and DEL.
7460
7461`alphanumeric'
7462 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7463 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7464
7465`letter'
7466 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7467 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7468
7469`ascii'
7470 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7471
7472`nonascii'
7473 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7474
7475`lower'
7476 matches anything lower-case.
7477
7478`upper'
7479 matches anything upper-case.
7480
7481`punctuation'
7482 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7483 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7484
7485`space'
7486 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7487
7488`word'
7489 matches anything that has word syntax.
7490
7491`(syntax SYNTAX)'
7492 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
7493 of the following symbols.
7494
7495 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
7496 `punctuation' (\\s.)
7497 `word' (\\sw)
7498 `symbol' (\\s_)
7499 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
7500 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
7501 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
7502 `string-quote' (\\s\")
7503 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
7504 `escape' (\\s\\)
7505 `character-quote' (\\s/)
7506 `comment-start' (\\s<)
7507 `comment-end' (\\s>)
7508
7509`(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
7510 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
7511
7512`(category CATEGORY)'
7513 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
7514 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
7515
7516 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
7517 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
7518 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
7519 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
7520 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
7521 `symbol' (\\c5)
7522 `digit' (\\c6)
7523 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
7524 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
7525 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
7526 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
7527 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
7528 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
7529 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
7530 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
7531 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
175573ac 7532 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
6260538e
GM
7533 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
7534 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
7535 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
7536 `ascii' (\\ca)
7537 `arabic' (\\cb)
7538 `chinese' (\\cc)
7539 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
7540 `greek' (\\cg)
7541 `korean' (\\ch)
7542 `indian' (\\ci)
7543 `japanese' (\\cj)
7544 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
7545 `latin' (\\cl)
7546 `lao' (\\co)
7547 `tibetan' (\\cq)
7548 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
7549 `thai' (\\ct)
7550 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
7551 `hebrew' (\\cw)
7552 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
7553 `can-break' (\\c|)
7554
7555`(not (category CATEGORY))'
7556 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
7557
7558`(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7559 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
7560
7561`(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7562 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
7563 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
7564
7565`(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7566 another name for `submatch'.
7567
7568`(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7569 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
7570 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
7571 regular expression.
7572
7573`(minimal-match SEXP)'
7574 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
e0e7f2d5 7575 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
6260538e
GM
7576 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
7577 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
7578
7579`(maximal-match SEXP)'
c3518b63 7580 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
6260538e
GM
7581
7582`(zero-or-more SEXP)'
7583 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7584
7585`(0+ SEXP)'
7586 like `zero-or-more'.
7587
7588`(* SEXP)'
7589 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7590
7591`(*? SEXP)'
7592 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7593
7594`(one-or-more SEXP)'
7595 matches one or more occurrences of A.
79014980 7596
6260538e
GM
7597`(1+ SEXP)'
7598 like `one-or-more'.
7599
7600`(+ SEXP)'
7601 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7602
7603`(+? SEXP)'
7604 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7605
7606`(zero-or-one SEXP)'
7607 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
79014980 7608
6260538e
GM
7609`(optional SEXP)'
7610 like `zero-or-one'.
7611
7612`(? SEXP)'
7613 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7614
7615`(?? SEXP)'
7616 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7617
7618`(repeat N SEXP)'
7619 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7620
7621`(repeat N M SEXP)'
7622 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7623
7624`(eval FORM)'
c3518b63 7625 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
6260538e
GM
7626 `regexp-quote' it.
7627
7628`(regexp REGEXP)'
7629 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
7630
697617d9
GM
7631*** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
7632
85c75536
MB
7633*** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
7634buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
7635the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
7636restriction to be restored incorrectly.
7637
0b8a3a6d
DL
7638*** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
7639`eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
028d739a 7640when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
0b8a3a6d
DL
7641multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
7642
fb2c6a6b 7643*** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
58008c36
EZ
7644`string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
7645if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
0b8a3a6d
DL
7646
7647*** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
7648changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
7649[\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
7650regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
7651the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
7652extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
7653bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
7654eight-bit-graphic.
7655
7656** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
7657
9b2a085d 7658A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
0b8a3a6d
DL
7659a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
7660character set as previously.
7661
7662*** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
7663They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
7664modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
7665
7666CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
7667characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
7668range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
7669case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
7670
7671FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
9b2a085d 7672name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
0b8a3a6d
DL
7673
7674*** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
7675registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
7676"fontset-default".
7677
7678*** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
7679argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
7680
7681** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
7682composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
7683buffers and strings.
7684
7685*** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
7686character' which is an independent character with a unique character
7687code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
7688have been deleted: composite-char-component,
7689composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
7690composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
7691The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
7692also been deleted.
7693
7694*** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
7695specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
7696`reference-point-alist' for more detail.
7697
7698*** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
7699MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
7700composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
7701may differ between buffer and string text.
7702
7703*** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
7704COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
7705
7706*** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
7707directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
7708Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
7709`composition' from STRING.
7710
7711*** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
7712a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
7713
7714*** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
7715obsolete.
7716
889be0a1
DL
7717** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
7718the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
7719
965bc065 7720** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
1e36ff68
DL
7721`mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
7722introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
7723U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
0b8a3a6d 7724
3d7a4ec8
EZ
7725Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
7726characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
7727etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
7728different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
7729which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
7730encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
7731
7732** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
7733It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
7734details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
23cfab61 7735
0b8a3a6d 7736** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
1e36ff68
DL
7737`japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
7738standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
7739
7740** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
7741have been introduced.
0b8a3a6d 7742
0b8a3a6d 7743** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
1e36ff68 7744have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
028d739a
DL
77450xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
7746eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
7747emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
2018166d
DL
7748buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
7749eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
7750must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
7751their multibyte equivalent.
0b8a3a6d 7752
f0124b4a
DL
7753** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
7754that offset in the file before writing.
7755
f98d3086
SM
7756** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
7757compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
7464346d 7758
612839b6
GM
7759** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
7760`*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
7761from which the command was issued.
7762
7763** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
7764`query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
7765`replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
7766additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
7767operate on.
7768
271b4185
GM
7769** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
7770to `window-buffer-height'.
7771
7772- Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
7773
7774Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
7775The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
7776lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
7777
7778Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
7779respectively.
7780
8a33023e 7781If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
271b4185
GM
7782COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
7783
7784The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
7785obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
7786on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
7787
7788Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
7789buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
7790possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
7791is currently displayed in some window.
7792
3c30cb6e
DL
7793** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
7794argument function's results.
7795
62f20204 7796** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
55bb62fd 7797signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
c8682017
EZ
7798`base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
779920, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
55bb62fd 7800sequence).
62f20204 7801
c0510d27 7802** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
b4da8dfa 7803header in the list of headers passed to it.
c0510d27
GM
7804
7805** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
7806ignores differences in case and text representation.
7807
7808** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
19d1bc27
GM
7809cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
7810as follows:
7811
7812 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
7813 nil don't display a cursor
7814 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
7815 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
7816 others display a box cursor.
7817
9a0dd3dc
GM
7818** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
7819an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
7820defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
7821set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
7822
d7b511c4 7823** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
dc1178bf 7824specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
d7b511c4
GM
7825the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
7826text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
7827
7828Example:
7829
7830 (string-to-syntax "()")
7831 => (4 . 41)
7832
1fa28578
GM
7833** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
7834other than 10.
7835
7836*** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
7837INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
7838
5d94f558 7839 #b1111
1fa28578 7840 => 15
5d94f558 7841 #b-1111
1fa28578
GM
7842 => -15
7843
7844*** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
7845
5d94f558 7846 #o666
1fa28578
GM
7847 => 438
7848
7849*** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
7850
5d94f558 7851 #xbeef
1fa28578
GM
7852 => 48815
7853
7854*** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
7855
5d94f558 7856 #2R-111
1fa28578 7857 => -7
5d94f558 7858 #25rah
1fa28578
GM
7859 => 267
7860
3d4ff2dd 7861** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
f98d3086 7862the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
e9b4e5ff
GM
7863and isn't a string.
7864
3d4ff2dd
GM
7865** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
7866a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
7867value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
7868not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
7869
16ce590d
DL
7870** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
7871
73825616 7872** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
16ce590d
DL
7873for a regexp in a string.
7874
7875** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
7876`mouse-position-function'.
7877
723e779c
GM
7878** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
7879that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
7880
d1e103b2
GM
7881** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
7882Keywords are now always considered constants.
7883
31047e0d
DL
7884** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
7885returns it.
7886
7a85e4df
GM
7887** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
7888returned by function `recent-keys'.
7889
02b14400
RS
7890** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
7891can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
3a426197 7892Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
02b14400
RS
7893etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
7894mode.
404fa7d6 7895
8964fec7
SM
7896** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
7897and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
7898
02b14400
RS
7899** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
7900has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
7901function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
7902returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
7903been performed."
7904
7905When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
7906and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
7907hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
7908then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
ef961722 7909
81da8b32
GM
7910** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
7911In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
7912and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
7913
9e207b90
GM
7914** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
7915with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
7916specified table.
7917
7918 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
7919
7920Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
03d9c64c
GM
7921TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
7922saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
7923what BODY returns.
9e207b90 7924
d7f89643 7925** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
95cd4c40 7926Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
8a33023e 7927Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
601e0081
SM
7928corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
7929Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
8964fec7 7930
dde9e75a
GM
7931** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
7932removed since it wasn't used by anything.
7933
9da30515
GM
7934** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
7935instead of being optional.
7936
d20679eb
GM
7937** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
7938modify read-only text.
7939
fbc164de
PE
7940** New functions and variables for locales.
7941
7942The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
7943decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
b718982a
PE
7944time functions like strftime. The new variables
7945`system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
7946locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
fbc164de
PE
7947
7948The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
7949environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
7950the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
b718982a
PE
7951environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
7952not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
7953`locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
7954`locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
fbc164de 7955
863476d1
SM
7956** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
7957To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
7958modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
7959start sequences.
7960
ef6d912c
GM
7961** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
7962because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
7963
a933dad1
DL
7964** New function `propertize'
7965
7966The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
7967strings with text properties.
7968
7969- Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
7970
7971Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
7972by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
7973PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
7974specified value of that property. Example:
7975
7976 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
7977
a933dad1
DL
7978** push and pop macros.
7979
02b14400
RS
7980Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
7981are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
a933dad1
DL
7982as the place that holds the list to be changed.
7983
7984(push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
7985(pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
7986 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
7987
02b14400
RS
7988** New dolist and dotimes macros.
7989
6c7fd5aa
RS
7990Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
7991are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
02b14400
RS
7992
7993(dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
7994 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
7995 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
7996 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
7997
7998(dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
7999 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
8000 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
8001 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8002
6c083b4c
GM
8003** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
8004[:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
8005class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
8006or a sign.
a933dad1
DL
8007
8008[:digit:] matches 0 through 9
8009[:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
8010[:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8011[:blank:] matches space and tab only
8012[:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8013 space, and DEL.
8014[:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8015 and DEL.
8016[:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
8017 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8018 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8019[:alpha:] matches letters.
8020 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8021 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8022[:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8023[:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8024[:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
8025[:punct:] matches punctuation.
8026 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8027 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8028[:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8029[:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
8030[:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
8031
a933dad1
DL
8032** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
8033
8034The following functions are defined for hash tables:
8035
8036- Function: make-hash-table ARGS
8037
8038The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
8039are optional. The following arguments are defined:
8040
8041:test TEST
8042
8043TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
8044Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
8045it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
8046
8047:size SIZE
8048
8049SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
8050many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
8051
8052:rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
8053
8054REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
8055full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
8056size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
80571.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
8058old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
8059
8060:rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
8061
8062THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
8063hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
8064(size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
8065
8066:weakness WEAK
8067
b548072f
GM
8068WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
8069`key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
8070`key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
8071collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
8072outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
a933dad1
DL
8073
8074- Function: makehash &optional TEST
8075
8076Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
8077
8078- Function: hash-table-p TABLE
8079
8080Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
8081
8082- Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
8083
8084Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
8085values are shared.
8086
8087- Function: hash-table-count TABLE
8088
8089Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
8090
8091- Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8092
8093Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
8094
8095- Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
8096
8097Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
8098
8099- Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8100
8101Returns the size of TABLE.
8102
d96d6bb0 8103- Function: hash-table-test TABLE
a933dad1
DL
8104
8105Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
8106
8107- Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
8108
8109Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
8110
8111- Function: clrhash TABLE
8112
8113Clear TABLE.
8114
8115- Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
8116
8117Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
8118not found.
8119
79214ddf 8120- Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
a933dad1
DL
8121
8122Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
8123another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
8124
8125- Function: remhash KEY TABLE
8126
8127Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
8128
8129- Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
8130
8131Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
8132arguments KEY and VALUE.
8133
8134- Function: sxhash OBJ
8135
8136Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
8137
8138- Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
8139
8140Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
8141a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
79214ddf 8142comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
a933dad1
DL
8143and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
8144of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
8145
8146TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
8147
8148HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
8149code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
8150integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
8151
8152Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
8153be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
8154
8155 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
8156 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
8157
8158 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
8159 (sxhash (upcase a)))
8160
79214ddf 8161 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
a933dad1
DL
8162 'case-fold-string-hash))
8163
8164 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
8165
a933dad1
DL
8166** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
8167
8168It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
8169circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
8170a cons cell which is its own cdr.
8171
a933dad1
DL
8172** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
8173
8174If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
8175#N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
8176
a933dad1
DL
8177** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
8178t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
8179specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
8180is too short to reach that column.
8181
a933dad1
DL
8182** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
8183now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
8184after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
8185two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
8186
8187If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
8188perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
8189and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
8190
a933dad1
DL
8191** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
8192to specify which buffer to return the size of.
8193
a933dad1
DL
8194** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
8195calendar-move-hook after moving point.
8196
a933dad1
DL
8197** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
8198directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
8199small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
8200small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
8201temporary-file-directory instead.
8202
a933dad1
DL
8203** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
8204the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
8205`before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
8206hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
8207
2018166d
DL
8208** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
8209elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
a933dad1 8210
a933dad1
DL
8211** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
8212
8213make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
8214creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
8215ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
8216
a933dad1
DL
8217** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
8218
8219The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
8220on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
8221is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
8222never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
8223ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
8224overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
8225
8226If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
8227that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
8228to get an error if the file exists at that time.
8229The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
8230
a933dad1
DL
8231** Function `format' now handles text properties.
8232
8233Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
8234If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
8235ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
8236result string.
8237
8238Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
8239string where arguments appear in the result string.
8240
8241Example:
8242
8243 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
8244 (s2 "world"))
8245 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
8246 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
b246b1f6 8247 (format s1 s2))
a933dad1
DL
8248
8249results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
8250
a933dad1
DL
8251** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
8252
8253Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
8254The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
8255argument in it.
8256
8257 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
8258 (arg "world"))
8259 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
8260 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
8261 (message msg arg))
8262
a933dad1
DL
8263** Sound support
8264
8265Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
8266(Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
8267
8268Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
8269(*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
8270to enable sound support.
8271
8272Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
8273list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
8274when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
8275functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
8276sound to play, before playing the sound.
8277
8278The following sound properties are supported:
8279
8280- `:file FILE'
8281
8282FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
8283searched relative to `data-directory'.
8284
6fb40beb
GM
8285- `:data DATA'
8286
8287DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
8288may be present, but not both.
8289
a933dad1
DL
8290- `:volume VOLUME'
8291
8292VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
82930..1. This property is optional.
8294
01242779
DL
8295- `:device DEVICE'
8296
8297DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
8298sound. The default device is system-dependent.
8299
a933dad1
DL
8300Other properties are ignored.
8301
01242779
DL
8302An alternative interface is called as
8303(play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
8304
a933dad1 8305** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
356673d4
DL
8306
8307** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
8308a keyword symbol.
fc91dc2d
GM
8309
8310** Changes to garbage collection
8311
8312*** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
8313of live and free strings.
8314
8315*** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
8316strings that have been consed so far.
8317
05197f40 8318\f
04545643
GM
8319* Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
8320Lisp Manual
8321
a299a6f0
GM
8322** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
8323mini-windows.
8324
26fcde61
MB
8325** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
8326argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
8327returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
ea4c1b7c 8328
a299a6f0 8329** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
82a452c8 8330
9a8d84ca 8331** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
2c69ced2
GM
8332
8333** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
8334image.
8335
8336- Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
8337
8338Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
8339
8340SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
8341measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
8342character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
8343font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
8344FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
8345
ebb8f116
GM
8346** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
8347has a mask bitmap.
8348
8349- Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
8350
8351Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
8352FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
8353or omitted means use the selected frame.
8354
0b8a3a6d
DL
8355** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
8356satisfying one of a list of specifications.
8357
0b8a3a6d
DL
8358** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
8359optional.
8360
f6499c03
DL
8361** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
8362below).
04545643 8363
05197f40 8364\f
a933dad1
DL
8365* New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
8366
f6d3257b
GM
8367** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
8368to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
8369
8370Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
8371text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
8372is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
8373your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
8374laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
8375just display it black instead.
8376
8377This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
8378a line like
8379
8380 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
8381
8382in your `.emacs'.
8383
a933dad1
DL
8384** New face implementation.
8385
8386Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
8387font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
8388
a933dad1
DL
8389*** New faces.
8390
8391Each face can specify the following display attributes:
8392
8393 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
79214ddf 8394
a933dad1
DL
8395 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
8396 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
79214ddf 8397
a933dad1 8398 3. Font height in 1/10pt
79214ddf 8399
a933dad1 8400 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
79214ddf 8401
a933dad1 8402 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
79214ddf 8403
a933dad1 8404 6. Foreground color.
79214ddf 8405
a933dad1
DL
8406 7. Background color.
8407
8408 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
8409
8410 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
8411
8412 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
8413
8414 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
8415
8416 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
8417 color.
8418
8419 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
8420 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
8421
8422Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
8423same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
8424frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
8425faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
0969bd6a 8426with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
a933dad1
DL
8427attributes mentioned above.
8428
8429There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
8430definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
8431created frames.
79214ddf 8432
a933dad1
DL
8433A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
8434have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
8435`fully-specified'.
8436
a933dad1
DL
8437*** Face merging.
8438
8439The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
8440combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
8441aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
8442properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
8443that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
8444results in a fully-specified face.
8445
a933dad1
DL
8446*** Face realization.
8447
8448After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
8449merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
8450realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
8451available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
8452face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
8453cache of the frame on which it was realized.
8454
8455Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
8456character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
8457for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
8458charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
8459
8460Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
8461specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
8462being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
8463the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
8464statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
8465
8466In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
8467`char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
84680x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
8469the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
8470initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
8471Emacs.
8472
8473Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
8474`enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
8475registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
8476with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
8477
a933dad1
DL
8478**** Clearing face caches.
8479
8480The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
8481on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
8482unused fonts.
8483
a933dad1 8484*** Font selection.
79214ddf 8485
a933dad1
DL
8486Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
8487given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
8488for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
8489
8490If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
8491pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
8492family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
8493property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
8494an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
8495
8496Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
8497against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
8498match for the given face attributes in this font list.
8499
8500Font selection can be influenced by the user.
8501
8502The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
8503attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
8504face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
8505names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
8506that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
8507width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
8508to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
8509
52d89894
GM
8510Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8511alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
89d57763 8512doesn't exist.
af4bb4c8
KH
8513
8514Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8a33023e 8515all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
af4bb4c8
KH
8516registry.
8517
8a33023e 8518Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
af4bb4c8
KH
8519slightly different.
8520
8521Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
8522
a933dad1 8523
a933dad1
DL
8524**** Scalable fonts
8525
8526Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
8527since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
8528servers.
8529
8530To enable scalable font use, set the variable
b246b1f6 8531`scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
a933dad1
DL
8532scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
8533Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
8534scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
8535that list. Example:
8536
8537 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
8538
8539allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
8540
a933dad1
DL
8541*** Functions and variables related to font selection.
8542
8543- Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
8544
8545Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
8546is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
8547string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
8548
8549If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
8550the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
8551FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
8552POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
8553SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
8554These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
8555if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
8556REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
8557the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
8558of the face font sort order.
8559
79214ddf 8560- Function: x-font-family-list
a933dad1
DL
8561
8562Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
8563omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
8564(FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
8565non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
8566
8567- Variable: font-list-limit
8568
8569Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
8570won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
8571matching font. The default is currently 100.
8572
a933dad1
DL
8573*** Setting face attributes.
8574
8575For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
8576with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
8577implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
8578`face-attribute'.
8579
8580Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
8581symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
8582
8583The following attributes are recognized:
8584
8585`:family'
8586
8587VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
8588or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
8589and `?' are allowed.
8590
8591`:width'
8592
8593VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
8594It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
8595`condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
8596`extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
8597
8598`:height'
8599
787345ff
MB
8600VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
8601in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
8602scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
8603height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
a933dad1
DL
8604
8605`:weight'
8606
8607VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
8608symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
8609`semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
8610
8611`:slant'
8612
8613VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
8614symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
8615`reverse-oblique'.
8616
8617`:foreground', `:background'
8618
8619VALUE must be a color name, a string.
8620
8621`:underline'
8622
8623VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
8624VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
8625a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
8626don't underline.
8627
8628`:overline'
8629
8630VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
8631VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
8632string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
8633overline.
8634
8635`:strike-through'
8636
8637VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
8638striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
8639face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
8640is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
8641
8642`:box'
8643
8644VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
8645around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
8646VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
8647of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
8648and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
8649VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
8650:color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
8651the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
8652specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
8653defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
8654the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
8655color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
8656should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
8657like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
8658that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
8659the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
8660box.
8661
8662`:inverse-video'
8663
8664VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
8665inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
8666
8667`:stipple'
8668
8669If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
8670The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
8671searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
8672HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
8673is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
8674explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
8675
8676For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
8677and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
8678
8679`:font'
8680
8681Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
8682XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
8683is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
8684versions of Emacs.
8685
8686For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
8687be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
8688must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
8689
8690Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
8691`defface'.
8692
787345ff
MB
8693`:inherit'
8694
8695VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
8696of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
8697like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
8698
a933dad1
DL
8699*** Face attributes and X resources
8700
8701The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
8702from X resources:
8703
8704 Face attribute X resource class
8705-----------------------------------------------------------------------
8706 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
8707 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
8708 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
8709 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
8710 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
8711 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
8712 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
8713 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
8714 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
8715 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
8716 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
8717 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
8718 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
79214ddf 8719 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
a933dad1
DL
8720 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
8721 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8722 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
8723 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
8724 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8725
a933dad1
DL
8726*** Text property `face'.
8727
8728The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
8729specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
8730specification can be
8731
87321. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
8733
87342. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
8735 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
8736 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
8737 for face attribute names.
8738
87393. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
8740 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
8741 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
8742
a933dad1
DL
8743** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
8744
acf3ecb7
EZ
8745The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
8746on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
8747the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
a933dad1 8748default. You can get defined colors with a call to
acf3ecb7 8749`defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
a933dad1
DL
8750used to clear the mapping table.
8751
acf3ecb7
EZ
8752** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
8753
8754The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
8755and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
8756type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
8757color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
8758display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
8759old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
8760`x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
8761compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
8762should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
8763modify their color-related behavior.
8764
8765The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
8766any frame type.
8767
8a5719f0
EZ
8768** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
8769
8770The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
8771`display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
8772`display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
8773`display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
8774`display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
8775`display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
8776display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
8777the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
8778platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
8779
27009a49
EZ
8780The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
8781display can display image files.
8782
a933dad1 8783** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
a933dad1 8784
463cac2d 8785This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
3b51cca0
MB
8786To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
8787the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
8788`Inviolable' option.
a933dad1 8789
d586cf1e 8790The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
a933dad1 8791end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
d586cf1e 8792Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
a933dad1 8793
463cac2d
GM
8794** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
8795
8796There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
8797buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
59927f88 8798property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
463cac2d 8799
9a9dfda8 8800Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
463cac2d 8801forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
9a9dfda8 8802to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
463cac2d 8803not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
fc7ac24f
GM
8804commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
8805boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
8806`inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
8807functions.
463cac2d
GM
8808
8809Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
9a9dfda8 8810a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
463cac2d 8811editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
a933dad1 8812
9a9dfda8
GM
8813The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
8814
59927f88 8815- Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
9a9dfda8
GM
8816
8817Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
59927f88 8818
9a9dfda8
GM
8819A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8820If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
9b2a085d 8821constrained position if that is different.
9a9dfda8
GM
8822
8823If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
8824positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
8825ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
59927f88 8826constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
9a9dfda8
GM
8827as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8828is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
59927f88
MB
8829fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
8830the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
8831also considered to be `on the boundary'.
9a9dfda8
GM
8832
8833If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
8834NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
8835unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
8836C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
8837only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
8838
59927f88
MB
8839If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
8840a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
8841
8842Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
8843
8844- Function: delete-field &optional POS
9a9dfda8 8845
59927f88 8846Delete the field surrounding POS.
9a9dfda8 8847A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
59927f88 8848If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9a9dfda8
GM
8849
8850- Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8851
8852Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
8853A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
59927f88
MB
8854If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8855If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
9a9dfda8
GM
8856field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
8857
8858- Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8859
8860Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
8861A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
59927f88
MB
8862If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8863If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
9a9dfda8
GM
8864then the end of the *following* field is returned.
8865
8866- Function: field-string &optional POS
8867
8868Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
8869A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
59927f88 8870If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9a9dfda8
GM
8871
8872- Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
8873
8874Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
8875A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
59927f88 8876If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9a9dfda8 8877
a933dad1
DL
8878** Image support.
8879
8880Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
8881strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
8882(AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
8883replaces the display of the characters having that property.
8884
8885If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
8886`(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
8887AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
8888window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
8889area.
8890
8891IMAGE is an image specification.
8892
8893*** Image specifications
8894
8895Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
8896is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
8897specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
35a5514b
GM
8898symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
8899described below are ignored.
a933dad1
DL
8900
8901The following is a list of properties all image types share.
8902
8903`:ascent ASCENT'
8904
576da55d
GM
8905ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
8906If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
5d94f558 8907to use for its ascent.
576da55d
GM
8908
8909If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
8910image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
8911
5d94f558 8912If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
04545643
GM
8913centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
8914of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
8915overlays that apply to the image.
a933dad1
DL
8916
8917`:margin MARGIN'
8918
b30623be
GM
8919MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
8920as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
8921horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
a933dad1
DL
8922
8923`:relief RELIEF'
8924
8925RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
8926around an image.
8927
f864120f 8928`:conversion ALGO'
a933dad1 8929
47e351a3
GM
8930Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
8931
8932ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
8933edge-detection algorithm to the image.
8934
8935ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
8936apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
8937nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
8938position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
8939around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
8940neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
8941transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
8942x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
8943below.
8944
8945 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
8946 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
8947 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
8948
8949The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
8950resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
8951multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
8952of the factors' absolute values.
8953
327652be 8954Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
a933dad1 8955
47e351a3
GM
8956 (1 0 0
8957 0 0 0
8958 9 9 -1)
8959
8960Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
8961
8962 ( 2 -1 0
8963 -1 0 1
8964 0 1 -2)
8965
ba9eeda1
GM
8966ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
8967``disabled''.
8968
47e351a3
GM
8969`:mask MASK'
8970
8971If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
8972the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
8973image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
8974background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
8a33023e 8975image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
47e351a3
GM
8976the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
8977GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
8978image.
a933dad1 8979
47e351a3
GM
8980If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
8981in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
8982`:mask nil'.
a933dad1
DL
8983
8984`:file FILE'
8985
8986Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
8987search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
8988building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
8989may be present in the image specification.
8990
518df5c4
GM
8991`:data DATA'
8992
8993Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
8994supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
8995present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
8996support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
8997
a933dad1
DL
8998*** Supported image types
8999
b246b1f6 9000**** XBM, image type `xbm'.
a933dad1
DL
9001
9002XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
0e467b97 9003properties supported are:
a933dad1
DL
9004
9005`:foreground FG'
9006
94736c7c 9007FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
0e467b97 9008meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
a933dad1 9009
46c5af7f 9010`:background BG'
a933dad1 9011
0e467b97 9012BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
94736c7c 9013meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
a933dad1
DL
9014
9015XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
9016case, the image specification must contain the following properties
9017instead of a `:file' property.
9018
9019`:width WIDTH'
9020
9021WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
9022
9023`:height HEIGHT'
9024
9025HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
9026
9027`:data DATA'
9028
9029DATA must be either
9030
9031 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
9032 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
9033
9034 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
9035
9036 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
9037 bitmap.
9038
c76e04a8
GM
9039 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
9040 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
9041 in the file.
9042
a933dad1
DL
9043**** XPM, image type `xpm'
9044
9045XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
9046`xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
9047found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
9048`--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
9049
9050Additional image properties supported are:
9051
9052`:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
9053
9054SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
9055name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
9056name.
9057
9058XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
9059add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
9060
a933dad1
DL
9061The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
9062to display compressed images.
9063
9064**** PBM, image type `pbm'
9065
9066PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
2b8e9c91 9067mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
0e467b97 9068mono images are:
2b8e9c91
GM
9069
9070`:foreground FG'
9071
94736c7c 9072FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
0e467b97 9073meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
2b8e9c91
GM
9074
9075`:background FG'
9076
0e467b97 9077BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
94736c7c 9078meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
a933dad1
DL
9079
9080**** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
9081
9082Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
0e467b97
JB
9083package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9084properties defined.
3bd37feb 9085
a933dad1
DL
9086**** TIFF, image type `tiff'
9087
9088Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
9089package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9090properties defined.
9091
9092**** GIF, image type `gif'
9093
9094Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
9095`libungif-4.1.0', or later.
9096
9097Additional image properties supported are:
9098
9099`:index INDEX'
9100
9101INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
ca205aa3
RS
9102multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
9103as a hollow box.
a933dad1
DL
9104
9105This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
9106For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
9107at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
9108every 0.1 seconds.
9109
9110(defun show-anim (file max)
9111 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
9112 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
9113
9114(defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
9115 (when (= idx max)
9116 (setq idx 0))
518df5c4 9117 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
a933dad1
DL
9118 (save-excursion
9119 (set-buffer buffer)
9120 (goto-char (point-min))
9121 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
9122 (insert-image img "x"))
9123 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
9124
9125**** PNG, image type `png'
9126
9127Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
9128package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9129properties defined.
9130
9131**** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
9132
9133Additional image properties supported are:
9134
9135`:pt-width WIDTH'
9136
9137WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
b246b1f6 9138integer. This is a required property.
a933dad1
DL
9139
9140`:pt-height HEIGHT'
9141
9142HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
b246b1f6 9143must be a integer. This is an required property.
a933dad1
DL
9144
9145`:bounding-box BOX'
9146
9147BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
9148the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
9149files. This is an required property.
9150
9151Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
9152lisp/gs.el.
9153
9154*** Lisp interface.
9155
79214ddf
FP
9156The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
9157which are supported in the current configuration.
a933dad1
DL
9158
9159Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
9160they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
9161The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
084cec2f
GM
9162manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
9163images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
a933dad1
DL
9164
9165*** Simplified image API, image.el
9166
9167The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
9168creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
9169can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
9170define an image based on available image types. The functions
9171`put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
9172buffer.
9173
a933dad1
DL
9174** Display margins.
9175
9176Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
9177and images.
9178
9179To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
9180`left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
9181`set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
9182obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
9183`right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
9184the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
9185of the display margins.
9186
9187You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
9188containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
9189one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
9190string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
9191in this file).
9192
a933dad1
DL
9193** Help display
9194
9195Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
9196moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
9197`help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
9198that have a `help-echo' property.
9199
9662da0b 9200If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
85a8aca9 9201is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
c20aeb83
GM
9202the window in which the help was found.
9203
9204If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
9205`help-echo' text property was found.
9206
9207If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
9208POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
9209
9210If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
5ed8d5af 9211the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
c20aeb83 9212mouse.
d5aa31d8 9213
9662da0b
GM
9214If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
9215string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
9216
9217For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
9218determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
9219property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
9220For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
9221used as help string.
a933dad1
DL
9222
9223The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
f0298744
DL
9224the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
9225causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
a933dad1 9226
a933dad1
DL
9227** Vertical fractional scrolling.
9228
9229The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
9230This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
9231
9232The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
9233scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
9234The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
9235scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
9236used.
9237
79214ddf
FP
9238 (global-set-key [A-down]
9239 #'(lambda ()
a933dad1 9240 (interactive)
79214ddf 9241 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
a933dad1 9242 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
79214ddf 9243 (global-set-key [A-up]
a933dad1
DL
9244 #'(lambda ()
9245 (interactive)
79214ddf 9246 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
a933dad1
DL
9247 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
9248
a933dad1
DL
9249** New hook `fontification-functions'.
9250
9251Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
9252when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
9253variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
9254is called with one argument, POS.
9255
9256At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
9257characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
9258as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
9259property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
9260`fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
9261
a933dad1
DL
9262** Tool bar support.
9263
9264Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
9265parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
9266controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
9267suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
9268`auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
9269automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
9270
9271*** Tool bar item definitions
9272
9273Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
9274`tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
9275where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
79214ddf 9276
a933dad1
DL
9277CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
9278evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
9279the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
9280property (see below).
79214ddf 9281
a933dad1
DL
9282BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
9283binding are currently ignored.
9284
9285The following properties are recognized:
9286
9287`:enable FORM'.
79214ddf 9288
a933dad1
DL
9289FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
9290or disabled.
79214ddf 9291
a933dad1 9292`:visible FORM'
79214ddf 9293
a933dad1 9294FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
79214ddf 9295
a933dad1
DL
9296`:filter FUNCTION'
9297
9298FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
9299FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
9300used instead of BINDING to display this item.
79214ddf 9301
a933dad1
DL
9302`:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
9303
9304TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
9305and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
79214ddf 9306
a933dad1
DL
9307`:image IMAGES'
9308
9309IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
9310image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
9311meaning of each of the four elements:
9312
9313 Index Use when item is
9314 ----------------------------------------
9315 0 enabled and selected
9316 1 enabled and deselected
9317 2 disabled and selected
9318 3 disabled and deselected
79214ddf 9319
4ba7246d
GM
9320If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
9321algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
9322
a933dad1 9323`:help HELP-STRING'.
79214ddf 9324
a933dad1
DL
9325Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
9326is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
9327
dab96841 9328The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
d1e68bce
DL
9329toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
9330to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
9331menu bar.
dab96841 9332
8628686a
DL
9333The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
9334dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
9335buffer-locally to override the global map.
9336
a933dad1
DL
9337*** Tool-bar-related variables.
9338
9339If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
9340resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
9341than 1/4 of the frame's size.
9342
79214ddf 9343If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
a933dad1
DL
9344raised when the mouse moves over them.
9345
9346You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
9347`tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
b30623be
GM
9348pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
9349vertical margins . Default is 1.
a933dad1
DL
9350
9351You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
9352`tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
9353
9354*** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
9355
9356You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
79214ddf 9357a tool bar item. If
a933dad1
DL
9358
9359 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
9360 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
9361 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
9362
9363is the original tool bar item definition, then
9364
9365 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
9366
9367makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
9368item.
9369
9370** Mode line changes.
9371
a933dad1
DL
9372*** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
9373
9374The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
9375that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
9376a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
9377
93781. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
9379a `local-map' text property.
9380
93812. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
9382that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
9383
93843. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
9385is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
9386`local-map' property.
9387
9388The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
9389properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
9390example.
9391
54522c9f
GM
9392*** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
9393evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
9394
a933dad1
DL
9395*** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
9396variable mode-line-format to nil.
9397
a933dad1
DL
9398*** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
9399
9400This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
9401`header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
9402completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
9403`default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
9404line.
9405
9406The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
9407`header-line'.
9408
9409The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
9410position in the header-line.
9411
a933dad1
DL
9412** Text property `display'
9413
623a0aae
GM
9414The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
9415replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
9416also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
9417the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
a933dad1
DL
9418below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
9419
623a0aae
GM
9420*** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
9421
9422To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
9423text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
9424
9425If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
9426marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
9427the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
9428is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9429simpler form STRING as property value.
9430
a933dad1
DL
9431*** Variable width and height spaces
9432
9433To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
9434specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
9435`(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
9436area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
9437marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
9438displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9439simpler form STRETCH as property value.
9440
9441The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
9442PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
9443properties described below.
9444
9445The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
9446characters having the `display' property.
9447
9448- :width WIDTH
9449
9450Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
9451character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
9452
9453- :relative-width FACTOR
9454
9455Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
9456first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
9457same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
9458width of that character by FACTOR.
9459
9460- :align-to HPOS
9461
9462Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
9463value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
9464
9465Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
9466
9467- :height HEIGHT
9468
9469Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
9470normal line height.
9471
9472- :relative-height FACTOR
9473
9474The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
9475of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
9476
9477- :ascent ASCENT
9478
9479Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
9480used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
9481baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
9482equal to 100.
9483
9484You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
9485
9486*** Images
9487
9488A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
9489. IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
9490in the display, the characters having this display specification in
9491their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
9492the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
9493`(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
9494area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
9495the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
9496as display specification.
9497
9498*** Other display properties
9499
c9e73000 9500- (space-width FACTOR)
a933dad1
DL
9501
9502Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
9503should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
9504integer or float.
9505
c9e73000 9506- (height HEIGHT)
a933dad1
DL
9507
9508Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
9509
9510If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
9511means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
9512the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
9513``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
9514a font is available counts as a step.
9515
9516If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
9517as tall as the frame's default font.
9518
9519If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
9520height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
9521
9522Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
9523`height' bound to the current specified font height.
9524
c9e73000 9525- (raise FACTOR)
a933dad1
DL
9526
9527FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
9528font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
9529raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
9530amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
c9e73000 9531`height' subproperty.
a933dad1
DL
9532
9533*** Conditional display properties
9534
9535All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
6c6caea2
GM
9536has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
9537only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
9538evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
9539conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
9540bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
9541the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
9542different when object is a string.
a933dad1
DL
9543
9544The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
6c6caea2 9545`(when t . SPEC)'.
a933dad1 9546
a933dad1
DL
9547** New menu separator types.
9548
9549Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
9550item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
9551treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
9552to specify other menu separator types.
9553
9554- `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
9555
9556No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
9557separator occurs.
9558
9559- `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
9560
9561A single line in the menu's foreground color.
9562
9563- `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
9564
9565A double line in the menu's foreground color.
9566
9567- `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
9568
9569A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9570
9571- `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
9572
9573A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9574
9575- `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
9576
f3780fe4 9577A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
a933dad1
DL
9578displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
9579
9580- `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
9581
9582A single line with 3D raised appearance.
9583
9584- `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
9585
9586A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
9587
9588- `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
9589
9590A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
9591
9592- `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
9593
9594Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9595
9596- `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
9597
9598Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
9599
9600- `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
9601
9602Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9603
9604- `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
9605
9606Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
9607
9608Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
9609the corresponding single-line separators.
9610
a933dad1
DL
9611** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
9612
9613The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
9614`scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
9615Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
9616that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
9617default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
9618default background is the background color of the frame, and the
9619default foreground is black.
9620
9621The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
9622(class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
9623`ScrollBarBackground').
9624
9625Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
9626settings for scroll bar colors.
9627
a933dad1
DL
9628** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
9629display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
9630
a933dad1
DL
9631** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
9632starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
9633on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
9634line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
9635the original window start.
9636
a933dad1
DL
9637** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
9638`hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
9639now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
9640
a933dad1
DL
9641** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
9642
9643A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
9644`window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
9645windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
9646other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
9647
9648The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
9649fixed-width and fixed-height.
9650
9651 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
9652
9653A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
9654fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
9655window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
9656change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
9657temporarily to nil, for example
9658
9659 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
9660 (enlarge-window 10))
9661
79214ddf 9662Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
a933dad1 9663or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
e411ce4b
EZ
9664
9665** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
9666terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
9667to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
9668overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
9669horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
9670support a vertical-bar cursor).
76299050 9671
3787e12e 9672
05197f40 9673\f
3787e12e
GM
9674* Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
9675
9676** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
9677input.
9678
9679** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
9680
9681** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
9682
9683** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
9684only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
9685exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
9686(e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
9687(e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
9688
9689** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
9690been added.
9691
05197f40 9692\f
3787e12e
GM
9693* Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
9694
9695** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
9696
0cb146bf 9697
05197f40 9698\f
3787e12e
GM
9699* Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
9700
9701** Not new, but not mentioned before:
9702M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
05197f40 9703\f
3787e12e
GM
9704* Changes in Emacs 20.4
9705
9706** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
9707
9708You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
9709Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
9710`.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
9711
9712If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
9713is the one that is used.
9714
9715** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
9716the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
9717Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
9718separate from the command's regular output.
9719Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
9720says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
9721In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
9722the buffer name.
9723
9724When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
9725output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
9726it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
9727cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
9728
9729** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
9730the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
9731is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
9732created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
9733
9734** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
9735example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
9736match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
9737quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
9738
9739** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
9740now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
9741if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
9742they never ignore case.
9743
9744** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
9745under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
9746applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
9747of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
9748just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
9749convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
9750part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
9751
9752If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
9753the same format that was used in the file before.
9754
9755You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
9756`inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
9757
9758** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
9759renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
9760This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
9761
9762** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
9763The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
9764buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
9765your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
9766is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
9767end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
9768Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
9769
9770The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
9771eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
9772control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
9773format. You can now customize these variables.
9774
9775** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
9776filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
9777filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
9778enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
9779
9780** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
9781in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
9782windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
9783
9784** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
9785dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
9786doesn't have any effect.
9787
9788** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
9789not one per buffer.
9790
9791** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
9792use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
9793 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
9794
9795** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
9796To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
9797`auto-show-mode' command.
9798
9799** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
9800avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
9801versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
9802choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
9803occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
9804
9805** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
9806cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
9807
9808** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
9809character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
9810feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
9811
9812** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
9813the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
9814interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
9815and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
9816
9817** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
9818
9819The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
9820that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
9821one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
9822codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
9823set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
9824
9825Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
9826from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
9827
9828IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
9829equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
9830a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
9831`?' on other systems.
9832
9833IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
9834feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
9835Unix.
9836
9837Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
9838current codepage when it starts.
9839
9840** Mail changes
9841
9842*** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
9843`mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
9844appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
9845non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
9846MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
9847headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
9848latin-1:
9849
9850 MIME-version: 1.0
9851 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
9852 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
9853
9854*** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
9855default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
9856default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
9857sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
9858buffer-file-coding-system.
9859
9860You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
9861sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
9862mail.
9863
9864*** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
9865if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
9866Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
9867list of possible coding systems.
9868
9869** CC Mode changes
9870
9871*** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
9872modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
9873longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
9874docstring for details.
9875
9876*** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
9877symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
9878found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
9879prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
9880lineup functions use this feature currently.
9881
9882*** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
9883"finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
9884
9885*** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
9886"catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
9887
9888*** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
9889from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
9890symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
9891c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
9892anonymous classes.
9893
9894*** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
9895syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
9896
9897*** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
9898inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
9899support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
9900function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
9901
9902*** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
9903(i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
9904brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
9905c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
9906(brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
9907
9908*** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
9909
9910*** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
9911
9912*** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
9913for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
9914
9915*** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
9916
9917*** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
9918associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
9919This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
9920circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
9921class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
9922
9923** Gnus changes.
9924
9925*** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
9926added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
9927Gnus manual for the full story.
9928
9929*** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
9930before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
9931group, which is created automatically.
9932
9933*** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
9934values.
9935
9936*** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
9937
9938*** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
9939outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
9940
9941*** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
9942`C-u C-c C-c'.
9943
9944*** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
9945
9946*** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
9947re-highlighting of the article buffer.
9948
9949*** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
9950
9951*** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
9952Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
9953
9954*** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
9955`a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
9956
9957*** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
9958control over simplification.
9959
9960*** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
9961
9962*** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
9963limit.
9964
9965*** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
9966
9967*** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
9968
9969*** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
9970If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
9971rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
9972
8a33023e 9973*** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
3787e12e
GM
9974`a' forces normal posting method.
9975
9976*** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
9977-- `W d'.
9978
9979*** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
9980to a non-nil value.
9981
9982*** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
9983where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
9984
9985*** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
9986has been added.
9987
9988*** A history of where mails have been split is available.
9989
9990*** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
9991
9992*** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
9993`gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
9994
9995*** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
9996`message-cite-original-without-signature'.
9997
9998*** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
9999
10000*** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
10001been added.
10002
10003*** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
10004`gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
10005
10006*** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
10007updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
10008
10009*** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
10010
10011*** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
10012
10013*** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
10014
10015** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
10016
10017*** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
10018options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
10019nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
10020
10021*** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
10022TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
10023of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
10024TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
10025can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
10026
10027*** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
10028All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
10029but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
10030the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
10031
10032*** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
10033the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
10034buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
10035mismatch.
10036
10037** Changes to RefTeX mode
10038
10039*** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
10040file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
10041
10042*** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
10043lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
10044characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
10045removed from the label.
10046
10047*** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
10048a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
10049
10050*** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
10051customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
10052
10053*** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
10054`reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
10055expressions.
10056
10057*** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
10058
10059** New/deleted modes and packages
10060
10061*** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
10062SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
10063
10064*** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
10065editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
10066SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
10067
10068*** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
10069changes with a special face.
10070
10071*** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
10072this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
10073Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
05197f40 10074\f
3787e12e
GM
10075* MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
10076
10077** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
10078This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
10079conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
10080and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
10081check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
10082
10083The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
10084Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
10085distribution when the config.bat script is run.
10086
10087** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
10088MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
10089controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
10090directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
10091Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
10092on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
10093string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
10094program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
10095printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
10096
10097** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
10098output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
10099available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
10100input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
10101temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
10102program.
10103
10104An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
10105and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
10106programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
10107automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
10108as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
10109ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
10110
10111** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
10112a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
10113MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
10114was not documented clearly before.
10115
10116** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
10117This includes Tetris and Snake.
05197f40 10118\f
3787e12e
GM
10119* Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
10120
10121** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
10122return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
10123They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
10124meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
10125
10126** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
10127WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
10128and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
10129
10130** Changes in the file-attributes function.
10131
10132*** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
10133It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
10134
10135*** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
10136the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
10137integers.
10138
10139** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
10140files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
10141arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
10142file names and attributes are returned.
10143
10144** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
10145sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
8a33023e 10146accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
3787e12e
GM
10147It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
10148returns the result.
10149
10150** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
10151to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
10152
10153** New functions for base64 conversion:
10154
10155The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
10156into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
10157performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
10158optionally.
10159
10160Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
10161job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
10162
10163**
10164The new function process-running-child-p
10165will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
10166terminal to its own child process.
10167
10168** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
10169when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
10170to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
10171itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
10172
10173** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
10174be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
10175
4a389f53 10176** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
3787e12e
GM
10177:included is an alias for :visible.
10178
10179easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
10180easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
10181to move or copy menu entries.
10182
10183** Multibyte editing changes
10184
10185*** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
10186an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
10187make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
10188work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
10189char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
10190 (setq char (sref str idx)
10191 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
10192The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
10193
10194If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
10195(say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
10196 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
10197
10198*** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
10199region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
10200deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
10201
8a33023e 10202 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
3787e12e
GM
10203
10204This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
10205across the boundary.
10206
10207*** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
10208`unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
10209 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
10210 contains 8-bit characters.
10211 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
10212 contains invalid characters.
10213
10214*** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
10215text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
10216preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
10217text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
10218way.
10219
10220*** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
10221If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
10222end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
10223prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
10224
10225*** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
10226compose Thai characters in a string.
10227
10228** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
10229argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
10230for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
10231menus should always use the third argument.
10232
10233** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
10234read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
10235arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
10236input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
10237
10238** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
10239of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
10240programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
10241inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
10242
10243** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
10244the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
10245returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
10246echo area contents.
10247
10248 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
10249
10250** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
10251NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
10252requested feature cannot be loaded.
10253
10254** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
10255foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
10256means to clear out that attribute.
10257
10258** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
10259gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
10260
10261** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
10262read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
10263unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
10264end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
10265
10266** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
10267the gap of the current buffer.
10268
10269** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
10270to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
10271current buffer.
10272
10273** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
10274facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
10275These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
10276it back in after any modifications have been made.
05197f40 10277\f
3787e12e
GM
10278* Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
10279
10280** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
10281the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
10282/usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
10283directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
10284subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
10285
10286Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
10287names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
10288Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
10289which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
10290these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
10291
10292Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
10293starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
10294time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
10295
10296This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
10297Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
10298to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
10299subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
10300`.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
10301results.
10302
10303** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
10304GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
10305that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
10306fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
05197f40 10307\f
3787e12e
GM
10308* Changes in Emacs 20.3
10309
10310** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
10311including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
10312it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
10313perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
10314
10315** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
10316specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
10317region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
10318further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
10319command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
10320within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
10321are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
10322region.
10323
10324In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
10325selective undo.
10326
10327** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
10328unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
10329buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
10330effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
10331Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
10332
10333The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
10334though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
10335-*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
10336load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
10337
10338** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
10339no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
10340enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
10341something that most users not do.
10342
10343** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
10344operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
10345The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
10346applications.
10347
10348C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
10349pasting operations.
10350
10351** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
10352setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
10353like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
10354printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
10355`ps-printer-name'.
10356
10357** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
10358minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
10359any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
10360except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
10361incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
10362hits a new word.
10363
10364Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
10365Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
10366to be confused by TeX commands.
10367
10368You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
10369correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
10370clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
10371of various alternative replacements and actions.
10372
10373Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
10374the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
10375corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
10376alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
10377flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
10378
10379Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
10380flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
10381
10382** Changes in input method usage.
10383
10384Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
10385the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
10386respectively.
10387
10388You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
10389
10390If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
10391of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
10392
10393The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
10394that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
10395
10396 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
10397
10398 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
10399
10400 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
10401 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
10402
10403 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
10404 given in the following case:
10405 o When you are using a complex input method.
10406 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
10407
10408If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
10409input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
10410and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
10411setting it to t is helpful.
10412
10413The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
10414
10415In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
10416keys:
10417 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
10418 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
10419 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
10420These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
10421environment.
10422
10423** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
10424names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
10425minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
10426get
10427
10428 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
10429
10430which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
10431
10432Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
10433Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
10434
10435** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
10436at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
10437its owner and group.
10438
10439** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
10440Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
10441
10442** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
10443contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
10444
10445** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
10446which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
10447in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
10448by the left edge of the rectangle.
10449
10450** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
10451increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
10452C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
10453for writing keyboard macros.
10454
10455** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
10456files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
10457frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
10458the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
10459additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
10460info.
10461
10462** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
10463
10464** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
10465query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
10466contents only.
10467
10468** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
10469confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
10470the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
10471says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
10472
10473** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
10474non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
10475literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
10476
10477** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
10478now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
10479Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
10480inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
10481
10482** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
10483failure if the command produces no output.
10484
10485** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
10486manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
10487the mouse.
10488
10489** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
10490mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
10491function and variable names.
10492
10493** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
10494reading specific files. This has higher priority than
10495file-coding-system-alist.
10496
10497** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
10498t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
10499converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
10500the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
10501according to the current fontset.
10502
10503** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
10504
10505The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
10506that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
10507nonascii-insert-offset.
10508
10509For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
10510enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
10511nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
10512characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
10513
10514** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
10515an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
10516
10517** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
10518letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
10519
10520** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
10521are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
10522command keys.
10523
10524** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
10525user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
10526
10527Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
10528user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
10529all variables that have documentation.
10530
10531** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
10532shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
10533that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
10534minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
10535it should show; the default is 20.
10536
10537Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
10538the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
10539of your input.
10540
10541** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
10542all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
10543recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
10544argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
10545the customizable options which were changed since that version.
10546Newly added options are included as well.
10547
10548If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
10549then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
10550for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
10551
10552This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
10553Customize menu.
10554
10555** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
10556the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
10557
10558** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
10559buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
10560invoked.
10561
10562** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
10563that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
10564The default is 1.
10565
10566** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
10567syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
10568new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
10569(C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
10570sensibly.
10571
10572** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
10573
10574** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
10575value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
10576two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
10577
10578** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
10579reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
10580for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
10581every night.
10582
10583** Desktop changes
10584
10585*** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
10586the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
10587
10588*** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
10589and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
10590
10591** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
10592read and post multi-lingual articles.
10593
10594** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
10595doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
10596be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
10597outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
10598the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
10599made invisible again.
10600
10601** Mail reading and sending changes
10602
10603*** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
10604the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
10605changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
10606toggle.
10607
10608*** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
10609now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
10610summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
10611the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
10612rmail-default-body-file.
10613
10614*** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
10615longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
10616handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
10617
10618*** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
10619it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
10620is evaluated to insert the signature.
10621
10622*** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
10623outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
10624handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
10625putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
10626transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
10627especially interested in trying feedmail.
10628
10629feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
10630feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
10631provided by feedmail are:
10632
10633**** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
10634stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
10635there is also a queue for draft messages
10636
10637**** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
10638be prompted for confirmation
10639
10640**** does smart filling of address headers
10641
10642**** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
10643the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
10644can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
10645
10646**** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
10647the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
10648/usr/lib/sendmail, and elisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
10649function for something else (10-20 lines of elisp)
10650
10651** Dired changes
10652
10653*** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
10654files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
10655
10656*** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
10657run Dired on the directory name at point.
10658
10659*** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
10660files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
10661for a specified regexp.
10662
10663** VC Changes
10664
10665*** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
10666conveniently.
10667
10668*** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
10669faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
10670Dired.
10671
10672VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
10673directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
10674listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
10675currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
10676
10677You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
10678then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
10679vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
10680control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
10681on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
10682
10683All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
10684is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
10685`v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
10686the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
10687`vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
10688
10689The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
10690toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
10691VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
10692`* l', to mark all files currently locked.
10693
10694Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
10695ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
10696command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
10697
10698*** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
10699file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
10700session to resolve them.
10701
10702Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
10703resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
10704contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
10705uses as well).
10706
10707*** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
10708command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
10709you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
10710either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
10711branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
10712If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
10713using ediff.
10714
10715** Changes in Font Lock
10716
10717*** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
10718are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
10719use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
10720unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
10721compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
10722
10723** Frame name display changes
10724
10725*** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
10726frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
10727raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
10728when many frames are invisible or iconified.
10729
10730*** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
10731frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
10732menu.
10733
10734** Comint (subshell) changes
10735
10736*** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
10737subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
10738with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
10739
10740*** There are new commands in Comint mode.
10741
10742C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
10743that is, the line after the last line you got.
10744You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
10745
10746C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
10747send the current line together with the following line, when you send
10748the following line.
10749
10750C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
10751which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
10752previously sent input.
10753
10754C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
10755it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
10756as the search string.
10757
10758*** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
10759automatically in compilation-mode windows.
10760
10761** C mode changes
10762
10763*** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
10764and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
10765assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
10766definition.
10767
10768*** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
10769(i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
10770Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
10771style is still the default however.
10772
10773*** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
10774
10775*** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
10776are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
10777them. They do not have key bindings by default.
10778
10779*** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
10780and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
10781
10782*** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
10783namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
10784
10785*** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
10786makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
10787
10788*** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
10789c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
10790
10791*** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
10792should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
10793package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
10794variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
10795
10796** Changes to hippie-expand.
10797
10798*** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
10799non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
10800which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
10801
10802*** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
10803non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
10804expanding dynamically.
10805
10806*** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
10807non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
10808
10809*** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
10810non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
10811this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
10812expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
10813
10814*** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
10815
10816** Changes in BibTeX mode.
10817
10818*** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
10819bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
10820automatic key generation. This replaces variable
10821bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
10822against the first word in the title.
10823
10824*** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
10825capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
10826bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
10827lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
10828lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
10829bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
10830
10831*** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
10832generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
10833replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
10834bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
10835
10836** Changes in vcursor.el.
10837
10838*** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
10839and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
10840variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
10841entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
10842`vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
10843in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
10844
10845*** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
10846Editing group once the package is loaded.
10847
10848*** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
10849generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
8a33023e 10850vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
3787e12e
GM
10851
10852*** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
10853vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
10854
10855** Ispell changes.
10856
10857*** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
10858buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
10859are identified by syntax tables in effect.
10860
10861*** Generic region skipping implemented.
10862A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
10863and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
10864defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
10865include:
10866
10867 o URLs are automatically skipped
10868 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
10869
10870*** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
10871
10872** Changes to RefTeX mode
10873
10874RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
10875large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
10876re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
10877section `Optimizations' in the manual.
10878
10879*** New recursive parser.
10880
10881The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
10882entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
10883recursive parser scans the individual files.
10884
10885*** Parsing only part of a document.
10886
10887Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
10888partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
10889the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
10890
10891 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
10892
10893*** Storing parsing information in a file.
10894
10895This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
10896
10897 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
10898
10899*** Using multiple selection buffers
10900
10901If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
10902for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
10903
10904 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
10905
10906*** References to external documents.
10907
10908The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
10909documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
10910documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
10911macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
10912RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
10913the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
10914The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
10915
10916*** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
10917
8a33023e 10918The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
3787e12e
GM
10919and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
10920
10921Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
10922the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
10923
10924*** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
10925
10926The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
10927buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
10928
10929*** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
10930
10931The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
10932contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
10933`reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
10934have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
10935enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
10936at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
10937more.
10938
10939*** Support for the varioref package
10940
10941The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
10942
10943*** New hooks
10944
10945Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
10946and citations are created. These hooks are
10947`reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
10948`reftex-format-cite-function'.
10949
10950*** Citations outside LaTeX
10951
10952The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
10953a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
10954
10955*** Short context is no longer fontified.
10956
10957The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
10958fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
10959fontified, use
10960
10961 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
10962
10963** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
10964With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
10965the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
10966directories that contain the same file name.
10967
10968Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
10969Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
10970file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
10971Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
10972have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
10973names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
10974directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
10975directory.
10976
10977** New modes and packages
10978
10979*** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
10980It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
10981it, but some do not.
10982
10983*** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
10984code.
10985
10986*** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
10987current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
10988around in a buffer.
10989
10990Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
10991
10992*** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
10993uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
10994be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
10995established system of notation similar to Chess.
10996
10997*** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
10998documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
10999guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
11000
11001*** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
11002available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
11003system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
11004simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
11005functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
11006the like.
11007
11008*** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
11009identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
11010
11011*** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
11012within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
11013used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
11014the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
11015
11016*** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
11017
11018 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
11019 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
11020 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
11021 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
11022 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
11023 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
11024 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
11025 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
11026 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
11027 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
11028 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
11029
11030 Platform-specific modes:
11031
11032 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
11033 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
11034 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
11035 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
11036 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
11037 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
11038 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
11039 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
11040 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
05197f40 11041\f
3787e12e
GM
11042* Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11043
11044** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
11045use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
11046That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
11047Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
11048
11049Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
11050you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
11051consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
11052
11053** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
11054and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
11055specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
11056searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
11057
11058** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
11059multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
11060character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
11061environment.
11062
11063** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
11064take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
11065string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
11066current input method for reading this one event.
11067
11068** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
11069now control whether to output certain characters as
11070backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
11071non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
11072characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
11073in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
05197f40 11074\f
3787e12e
GM
11075* Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11076
11077** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
11078of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
11079
11080** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
11081in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
11082always increases point by 1.
11083
11084The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
11085considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
11086
11087See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
11088
11089** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
11090Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
11091default value changed. For example,
11092
11093 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
11094 :type 'integer
11095 :group 'foo
11096 :version "20.3")
11097
11098 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
11099 :version "20.3")
11100
11101If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
11102default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
11103is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
11104`:version' in the top level group.
11105
11106This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
11107
11108** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
11109starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
11110
11111However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
11112symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
11113support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
11114to themselves.
11115
11116If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
11117this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
11118values whatever.
11119
11120** There is a new debugger command, R.
11121It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
11122in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
11123
11124** Frame-local variables.
11125
11126You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
11127the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
11128local bindings for that variable.
11129
11130These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
11131frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
11132modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
11133parameter name.
11134
11135Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
11136Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
11137active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
11138that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
11139
11140It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
11141clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
11142very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
11143through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
11144
11145** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
11146"symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
11147evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
11148makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
11149See the documentation in sregex.el.
11150
11151** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
11152is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
11153parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
11154The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
11155
11156** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
11157If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
11158
11159** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
11160known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
11161define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
11162
11163** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
11164when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
11165it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
11166history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
11167
11168The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
11169return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
11170empty input.
11171
11172** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
11173for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
11174`iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
11175Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
11176`read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
11177
11178** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
11179echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
11180a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
11181default password to use if the user enters nothing.
11182
11183** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
11184specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
11185function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
11186place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
11187non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
11188
11189** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
11190If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
11191up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
11192end of the window, even if this requires computation.
11193
11194** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
11195which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
11196If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
11197
11198** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
11199holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
11200was directed to display this buffer.
11201
11202** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
11203with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
11204describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
11205other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
11206set-window-configuration.
11207
11208** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
11209window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
11210positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
11211windows and the choice of buffers to display.
11212
11213** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
11214override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
11215look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
11216
11217If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
11218non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
11219map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
11220
11221minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
11222and it is meant to be set by major modes.
11223
11224** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
11225except that it discards all text properties from the result.
11226
11227** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
11228USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
11229floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
11230
11231** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
11232to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
11233in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
11234it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
11235
11236** Menu changes
11237
11238*** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
11239keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
11240better supported.
11241
11242The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
11243a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
11244you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
11245can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
11246then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
11247
11248*** A new format for menu items is supported.
11249
11250In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
11251 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
11252defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
11253starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
11254
11255The format is:
11256 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
11257 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
11258where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
11259string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
11260The supported properties include
11261
11262:enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11263 item is enabled.
11264:visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11265 item should appear in the menu.
11266:filter FILTER-FN
11267 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
11268 which will be REAL-BINDING.
11269 It should return a binding to use instead.
11270:keys DESCRIPTION
11271 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
f3780fe4 11272 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
3787e12e
GM
11273 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
11274:key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
11275 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
11276 keyboard binding.
11277:key-sequence nil
11278 This means that the command normally has no
11279 keyboard equivalent.
11280:help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
11281:button (TYPE . SELECTED)
11282 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
11283 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
11284 value says whether this button is currently selected.
11285
11286Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
11287Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
11288
11289(menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
11290
11291** New event types
11292
11293*** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
11294mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
11295corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
11296which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
11297
11298 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
11299
11300where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11301same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
11302indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
11303negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
11304the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
11305forward, away from the user.
11306
11307As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11308
11309*** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
11310files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
11311and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
11312filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
11313loaded into Emacs. The format is:
11314
11315 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
11316
11317where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11318same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
11319that were dragged and dropped.
11320
11321As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11322
11323** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
11324
11325*** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
11326any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
11327to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
11328
11329*** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
11330can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
11331that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
11332
11333*** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
11334in Emacs 19 and before.
11335
11336The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
11337The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
11338
11339*** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
11340buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
11341unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
11342representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
11343
11344This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
11345as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
11346viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
11347one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
11348will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
11349
11350This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
11351representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
11352(including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
11353consistent with the new representation.
11354
11355*** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
11356representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
11357about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
11358however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11359
11360The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
11361nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
11362using the table nonascii-translation-table.
11363
11364*** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
11365representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
11366representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11367
11368The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
11369loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
11370is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
11371
11372*** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11373which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
11374
11375*** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11376which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
11377
11378*** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
11379portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
11380so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
11381You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
11382
11383*** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
11384it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
11385
11386*** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
11387convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
11388buffer or string being searched.
11389
11390One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
11391[...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
11392searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
11393searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
11394obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
11395you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
11396expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
11397
11398*** Structure of coding system changed.
11399
11400All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
11401by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
11402which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
11403as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
11404vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
11405your own alias name of a coding system by the function
11406define-coding-system-alias.
11407
11408The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
11409the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
11410access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
11411pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
11412character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
11413safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
11414'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
11415`iso-8859-1'.
11416
11417Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
11418The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
11419coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
11420(coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
11421
11422Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
11423also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
11424are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
11425the other character sets and read it back correctly.
11426
11427*** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
11428proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
11429This function requires a user interaction.
11430
11431*** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
11432find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
11433select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
11434systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
11435a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
11436select-safe-coding-system.
11437
11438*** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
11439decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
11440last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
11441was done.
11442
11443*** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
11444used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
11445coding systems used by some specific language environment.
11446
11447*** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
11448return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
11449characters are found, they now return a list of single element
11450`undecided' or its subsidiaries.
11451
11452*** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
11453coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
11454coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
11455converted.
11456
11457*** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
11458coding system for communicating with other X clients.
11459
11460*** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
11461character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
11462character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
11463each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
11464either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
11465range of characters.
11466
11467*** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
11468Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
11469
11470*** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
11471in the current buffer at position POS.
11472
11473*** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
11474input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
11475function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
11476character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
11477event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
11478binding input-method-function to nil.
11479
11480The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
11481method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
11482input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
11483the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
11484not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
11485
11486The input method function is not called when reading the second and
11487subsequent events of a key sequence.
11488
11489*** You can customize any language environment by using
11490set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
11491
11492The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
11493customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
11494instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
11495environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
11496exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
05197f40 11497\f
3787e12e
GM
11498* Changes in Emacs 20.1
11499
11500** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
11501options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
11502at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
11503tree structure.
11504
11505M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
11506user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
11507
11508With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
11509session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
11510in your .emacs file.)
11511
11512** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
11513You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
11514
11515** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
11516This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
11517
11518** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
11519immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
11520kills the region.
11521
11522The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
11523delete the character before point, as usual.
11524
11525** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
11526on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
11527by setting search-highlight to nil.)
11528
11529** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
11530insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
11531the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
11532onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
11533history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
11534past.)
11535
11536** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
11537This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
11538in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
11539TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
11540makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
11541
11542As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
11543and is an alias for it.
11544
11545If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
11546use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
11547
11548** Scrolling changes
11549
11550*** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
11551position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
11552
11553In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
11554on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
11555where it started.
11556
11557*** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
11558move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
11559screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
11560does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
11561
11562*** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
11563top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
11564comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
11565recenters the window.
11566
11567** International character set support (MULE)
11568
11569Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
11570including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
11571Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
11572Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
11573features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
11574MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
11575
11576Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
11577coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
11578character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
11579variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
11580into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
11581
11582Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
11583generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
11584supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
11585language, to make it possible to type them.
11586
11587The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
11588character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
11589
11590The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
11591to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
11592
11593You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
11594
11595 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
11596
11597Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
11598characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
11599argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
11600already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
11601characters for their work until they want to change.
11602
11603*** Input methods
11604
11605An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
11606specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
11607has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
11608the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
11609support several input methods.
11610
11611The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
11612another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
11613work.
11614
11615A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
11616characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
11617composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
11618consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
11619sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
11620letter.
11621
11622The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
11623by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
11624First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
11625marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
11626mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
11627
11628None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
11629they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
11630phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
11631converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
11632
11633Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
11634word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
11635typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
11636the first guess is wrong.
11637
11638*** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
11639turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
11640
11641If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
11642byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
11643they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
11644the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
11645
11646However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
11647use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
11648includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
11649translate automatically to and from either one.
11650
11651*** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
11652
11653Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
11654file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
11655sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
11656what you want.
11657
11658If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
11659example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
11660system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
11661multibyte characters in that buffer.
11662
11663If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
11664character conversion as well.
11665
11666*** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
11667
11668A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
11669Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
11670requires using many fonts.
11671
11672Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
11673collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
11674
11675A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
11676the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
11677have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
11678you would use a font.
11679
11680If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
11681specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
11682display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
11683
11684The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
11685(that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
f327c2f9 11686characters).
3787e12e
GM
11687
11688*** Defining fontsets.
11689
11690Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
11691chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
11692with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
11693
11694Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
11695of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
11696`fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
11697standard fontset are created automatically.
11698
11699If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
11700argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
11701FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
11702with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
11703name is `fontset-startup'.
11704
11705Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
11706The resource value should have this form:
11707 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
11708FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
11709 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
11710 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
11711 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
11712The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
11713of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
0969bd6a
EZ
11714CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
11715should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
3787e12e
GM
11716
11717Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
11718last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
11719You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
11720
11721For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
11722font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
11723following resource,
11724 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
11725the font for ASCII is generated as below:
11726 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
11727Here is the substitution rule:
11728 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
11729 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
11730 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
11731 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
11732 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
11733
11734The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
11735fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
11736that function explicitly to create a fontset.
11737
11738With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
11739like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
11740name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
11741fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
11742fontsets.
11743
11744*** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
11745defaults for a particular choice of language.
11746
11747Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
11748method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
11749visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
11750already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
11751language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
11752system for new files that you create.
11753
11754It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
11755set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
11756whole Emacs session.
11757
11758For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
11759chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
11760with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
11761
11762*** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
11763specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
11764specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
11765the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
11766coding systems that Emacs supports.
11767
11768*** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
11769lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
11770This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
11771After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
11772is used for *the immediately following command*.
11773
11774So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
11775write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
11776
11777If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
11778then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
11779
c3518b63 11780For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
3787e12e
GM
11781visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
11782
11783*** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
11784construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
11785to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
11786specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
11787of the file.
11788
11789*** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
11790the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
11791code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
11792translated into that character code.
11793
11794This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
11795various countries to support the languages of those countries.
11796
11797By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
11798
11799*** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
11800the coding system for keyboard input.
11801
11802Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
11803with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
11804some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
11805
11806By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
11807
11808Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
11809input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
11810translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
11811to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
11812designed to work with terminals.
11813
11814*** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
11815specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
11816This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
11817has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
11818translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
11819in the corresponding buffer.
11820
11821By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
11822
11823*** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
11824to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
11825It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
11826
11827*** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
11828an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
11829command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
11830want to use.
11831
11832C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
11833method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
11834
11835*** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
11836layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
11837remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
11838which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
11839
11840*** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
11841the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
11842related information.
11843
11844*** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
11845HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
11846scripts.
11847
11848*** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
11849information about the support for a particular language.
11850You specify the language as an argument.
11851
11852*** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
11853the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
11854first dash.
11855
11856A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
11857(except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
11858whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
118591 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
11860
11861 A alternativnyj (Russian)
11862 B big5 (Chinese)
11863 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
11864 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
11865 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
11866 E euc-japan (Japanese)
11867 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11868 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
11869 K euc-korea (Korean)
11870 R koi8 (Russian)
11871 Q tibetan
11872 S shift_jis (Japanese)
11873 T lao
11874 T tis620 (Thai)
11875 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
11876 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11877 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
11878 v viqr (Vietnamese)
11879 z hz (Chinese)
11880
11881When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
11882two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
11883coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
11884keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
11885
11886*** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
11887conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
11888
11889When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
11890into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
11891rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
11892Rmail files themselves.
11893
11894*** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
11895conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
11896
11897Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
11898for sending mail:
11899
11900- If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
11901- Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
11902- Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
11903 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
11904- Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
11905
11906*** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
11907to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
11908Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
11909translations.
11910
11911** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
11912of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
11913insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
11914without any conversion.
11915
11916** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
11917You can now specify any number of octal digits.
11918RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
11919any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
11920
11921** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
11922functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
11923
11924Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
11925Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
11926
11927Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
11928mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
11929
11930** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
11931complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
11932in the buffer before point.
11933
11934With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
11935symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
11936you are using.
11937
11938With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
11939just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
11940
11941** File locking works with NFS now.
11942
11943The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
11944in the same directory as FILENAME.
11945
11946This means that collision detection between two different machines now
11947works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
11948can become a bottleneck.
11949
11950The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
11951does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
11952create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
11953file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
11954rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
11955so useful that the change is worth while.
11956
11957When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
11958are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
11959collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
11960tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
11961
11962** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
11963it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
11964show-paren-mode.
11965
11966** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
11967selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
11968delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
11969
11970** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
11971within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
11972complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
11973
11974** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
11975it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
11976set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
11977
11978** Changes in View mode.
11979
11980*** Several new commands are available in View mode.
11981Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
11982
11983*** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
11984view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
11985
11986*** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
11987previous state.
11988
11989*** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
11990scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
11991
11992*** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
11993non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
11994not just the selected window.
11995
11996*** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
11997read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
11998turns View mode on or off.
11999
12000*** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
12001how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
12002delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
12003
12004** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
12005now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
12006
12007** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
12008has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
12009presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
12010which version to compare with.
12011
12012** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
12013blocks if a match is inside the block.
12014
12015The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
12016is outside the block. By customizing the variable
12017isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
12018shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
12019
12020By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
12021of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
12022blocks, all of them or none.
12023
12024** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
12025current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
12026confirmation first.
12027
12028** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
12029now changes the major mode according to that file name.
12030However, the mode will not be changed if
12031(1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
12032(2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
12033 not suitable for ordinary files, or
12034(3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
12035
12036This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
12037
12038However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
12039these commands do not change the major mode.
12040
12041** M-x occur changes.
12042
12043*** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
12044it performs a case-sensitive search.
12045
12046*** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
12047if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
12048using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
12049
12050** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
12051in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
12052window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
12053that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
12054buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
12055
12056** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
12057after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
12058appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
12059come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
12060
12061** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
12062selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
12063buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
12064
12065** Outline mode changes.
12066
12067*** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
12068
12069*** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
12070
12071** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
12072you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
12073Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
12074was already active.
12075
12076The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
12077unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
12078get confused by it.
12079
12080If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
12081set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
12082
12083** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
12084
12085*** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
12086conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
12087character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
12088including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
12089
12090The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
12091mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
12092copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
12093
12094*** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
12095are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
12096values.
12097
12098`dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
12099case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
12100`dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
12101case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
12102
12103** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
12104certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
12105can be. The default value is 30.
12106
12107** Changes in Mail mode.
12108
12109*** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
12110Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
12111composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
12112`mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
12113`sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
12114behavior.
12115
12116C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
12117compose-mail-other-frame.
12118
12119*** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
12120the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
12121replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
12122buffer that shows the original message.
12123
12124*** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
12125with separator lines around the contents.
12126
12127*** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
12128in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
12129definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
12130need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
12131
12132*** New features in the mail-complete command.
12133
12134**** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
12135for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
12136controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
12137Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
12138
12139**** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
12140to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
12141/etc/passwd.
12142
12143**** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
12144to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
12145/etc/passwd.
12146
12147** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
12148special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
12149directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
12150reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
12151
12152Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
12153when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
12154be taken to be magic.
12155
12156** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
12157files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
12158available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
12159
12160M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
12161(-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
12162
12163** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
12164suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
12165
12166In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
12167
12168new key dired.el binding old key
12169------- ---------------- -------
12170 * c dired-change-marks c
12171 * m dired-mark m
12172 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
12173 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
12174 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
12175 * u dired-unmark u
12176 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
3a426197 12177 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
3787e12e
GM
12178 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
12179 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
12180 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
12181 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
12182
12183** Rmail changes.
12184
12185*** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
12186saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
12187chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
12188each time you run it.
12189
12190*** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
12191whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
12192
12193*** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
12194messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
12195means to move in the opposite direction.
12196
12197*** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
12198you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
12199
12200*** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
12201just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
12202It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
12203can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
12204for output.
12205
12206** Gnus changes.
12207
12208*** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
12209
12210*** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
12211Gnus.
12212
12213*** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
12214`and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
12215
12216*** Article washing status can be displayed in the
12217article mode line.
12218
12219*** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
12220
12221*** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
12222
12223(setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
12224
12225*** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
12226are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
12227`gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
12228
12229*** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
12230
12231*** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
12232
12233*** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
12234See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
12235
12236*** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
12237Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
12238used to pick articles.
12239
12240*** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
12241another have been added.
12242
12243 `M-x gnus-change-server'
12244
12245*** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
12246generating lines in buffers.
12247
12248*** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
3a426197 12249`C-M-_'.
3787e12e
GM
12250
12251*** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
12252
12253*** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
12254
12255 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
12256
12257*** Scores can be decayed.
12258
12259 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
12260
12261*** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
12262Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
12263
12264*** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
12265the native server.
12266
12267 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
12268
12269*** A new command for reading collections of documents
3a426197 12270(nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
3787e12e
GM
12271
12272*** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
12273
12274*** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
12275even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
12276
12277*** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
12278(DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
12279
12280 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
12281 a group.
12282
12283*** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
12284sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
12285
12286 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
12287
12288*** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
12289
12290 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
12291
12292*** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
12293
12294 Use the `Y c' command.
12295
12296*** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
12297
12298*** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
12299
12300 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
12301
12302*** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
12303from incoming mail before saving the mail.
12304
12305 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
12306
12307*** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
12308
12309*** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
12310the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
12311
12312 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
12313
12314Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
12315and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
12316from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
12317hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
12318this issue.)
12319
12320Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
12321automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
12322particular news group. This can be done by:
12323
12324 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
12325
12326Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
12327of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
12328"XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
12329system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
12330for reading and posting).
12331
12332CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
12333 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
12334Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
12335newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
12336there.
12337
12338Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
12339default. Here are some of these default settings:
12340
12341 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
12342 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
12343 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
12344 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
12345 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
12346
12347When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
12348the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
12349
12350** CC mode changes.
12351
12352*** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
12353code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
12354values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
12355this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
12356Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
12357loaded.
12358
12359If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
12360Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
12361style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
12362share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
12363c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
12364must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
12365
12366*** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
12367of the current buffer.
12368
12369*** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
12370it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
12371of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
12372
12373*** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
12374style that the Python developers like.
12375
12376*** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
12377This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
12378just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
12379
12380** VC Changes [new]
12381
9614842d 12382*** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
3787e12e
GM
12383name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
12384directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
12385
12386This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
12387master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
12388developers.
12389
12390You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
12391RET in a buffer visiting that file.
12392
12393*** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
12394other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
12395writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
12396calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
12397
12398*** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
12399version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
12400
12401** Calendar changes.
12402
9614842d
JW
12403*** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
12404subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
12405you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
12406following/previous years.
12407
12408*** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
12409the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
12410calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
12411each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
12412calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
12413supposed attribute of God.
3787e12e
GM
12414
12415** ps-print changes
12416
2261f14e
GM
12417There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
12418layout.
3787e12e 12419
2261f14e 12420*** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
3787e12e 12421
2261f14e
GM
12422Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
12423be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
12424printer system has this behavior, set variable
12425`ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
3787e12e 12426
2261f14e
GM
12427If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
12428blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
a5d03456 12429very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
3787e12e 12430
2261f14e
GM
12431The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
12432setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
3787e12e 12433
2261f14e
GM
12434 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
12435 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
12436 printing for your printer.
3787e12e 12437
2261f14e
GM
12438 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
12439 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
3787e12e 12440
2261f14e
GM
12441 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
12442 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
3787e12e 12443
2261f14e
GM
12444The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
12445opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
12446`ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
12447bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
12448ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
12449This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
12450The default value is nil.
3787e12e 12451
2261f14e
GM
12452The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
12453properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
3787e12e 12454
2261f14e
GM
12455 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
12456 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
12457 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
12458 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
12459 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
12460 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
12461 color). The default is 0 ("black").
3787e12e 12462
2261f14e
GM
12463 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
12464 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
12465
12466 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
12467 The default is 0 ("black").
12468
12469 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
12470 The default is 0 ("black").
12471
12472 border-width Specify the border width.
12473 The default is 0.4.
12474
12475Any other property is ignored.
12476
12477Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
12478`ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
12479documentation).
12480
12481Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
12482`ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
12483`ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
12484`ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
12485`ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
12486controlling headers.
3787e12e 12487
2261f14e
GM
12488*** Color management (subgroup)
12489
12490If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
12491color.
12492
12493*** Face Management (subgroup)
3787e12e 12494
2261f14e
GM
12495If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
12496set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
12497background should be used. Valid values are:
12498
12499 t always use face background color.
12500 nil never use face background color.
12501 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
12502
12503*** N-up printing (subgroup)
12504
12505The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
12506sheet of paper.
12507
12508The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
12509between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
12510
12511If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
12512each page.
12513
12514The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
12515on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
12516`ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
12517
12518 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
12519 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
12520 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
3787e12e 12521
2261f14e
GM
12522 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
12523 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
12524 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
12525
12526 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
12527 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
12528 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
12529
12530 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
12531 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
12532 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
3787e12e 12533
2261f14e
GM
12534Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
12535
12536*** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
3787e12e 12537
2261f14e
GM
12538The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
12539RGB color.
12540
12541The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
12542continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
12543to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
12544
12545 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
12546 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12547 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12548 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12549 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12550 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
12551 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
12552 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
12553 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12554 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12555 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12556 10 + 10 +
12557 11 + 11 +
12558 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12559 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12560 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
12561 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
12562 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
12563 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12564 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12565 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12566 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
12567 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
12568 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
12569 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
12570 22 + 22 +
12571 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12572
12573Any other value is treated as `nil'.
12574
12575
12576*** Printer management (subgroup)
12577
12578The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
12579some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
12580`ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
12581utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
12582to "-P".
12583
12584The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
12585paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
12586non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
12587
12588The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
12589should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
12590do so.
12591
12592*** Page settings (subgroup)
12593
12594If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
12595error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
12596indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
12597instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
12598the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
12599by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
12600`setpagedevice'.
12601
12602The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
12603printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
12604`upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
12605
12606The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
12607it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
12608integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
12609specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
12610is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
12611its TO, are ignored.
12612
12613The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
12614pages. Valid values are:
12615
12616 nil print all pages.
12617
12618 `even-page' print only even pages.
12619
12620 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
12621
12622 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
12623 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12624 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
12625 print only the even sheet of paper.
12626
12627 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
12628 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12629 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
12630 only the odd sheet of paper.
12631
12632Any other value is treated as nil.
12633
12634If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
12635are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
12636`ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
12637
12638 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
12639
12640and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
12641`ps-n-up-printing', we get:
12642
12643`ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
12644 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12645 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
12646 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12647 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12648 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12649 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12650
12651`ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
12652 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12653 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
12654 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
12655 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
12656 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
12657 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
12658
12659*** Miscellany (subgroup)
12660
12661The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
12662messages should be sent.
12663
12664It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
12665front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
12666`ps-user-defined-prologue'.
12667
12668The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
12669
12670The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
12671points for line numbers.
12672
12673The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
12674numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
12675
12676The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
12677line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
12678to 2, the printing will look like:
12679
12680 1 one line
12681 one line
12682 3 one line
12683 one line
12684 5 one line
12685 one line
12686 ...
12687
12688Valid values are:
12689
12690integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
12691 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
12692 is used.
12693
12694`zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
12695 zebra stripe is to be printed.
12696
12697Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
12698
12699The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
12700the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
12701`ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
127023, the output will look like:
12703
12704 one line
12705 one line
12706 3 one line
12707 one line
12708 one line
12709 6 one line
12710 one line
12711 one line
12712 9 one line
12713 one line
12714 ...
12715
12716The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
12717where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
12718
12719The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
12720for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12721`ps-font-size').
12722
12723The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
12724in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12725`ps-font-size').
12726
12727The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
12728
12729The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
12730start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
3787e12e
GM
12731
12732** hideshow changes.
12733
12734*** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
12735C++, ; for lisp).
12736
12737*** Support for java-mode added.
12738
12739*** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
12740in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
12741
f3780fe4 12742*** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
3787e12e
GM
12743the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
12744way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
12745
12746*** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
12747robust and a lot faster.
12748
12749*** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
12750
12751*** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
12752to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
12753documentation for more details.
12754
12755** Changes in Enriched mode.
12756
12757*** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
12758filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
12759of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
12760use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
12761the next time unless the fill-column is different.
12762
12763*** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
12764distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
12765as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
12766as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
12767
12768** Font Lock mode
12769
12770*** Custom support
12771
12772The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
12773font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify the
12774faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new custom
12775group font-lock-highlighting-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in
12776your ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
12777consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
12778
12779You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
12780
12781*** Maximum decoration
12782
12783Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
12784default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
12785of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
12786supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
12787to get the old behavior.
12788
12789*** New support
12790
12791Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
12792
12793Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
12794support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
12795
12796*** Configurable support
12797
12798Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
12799additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
12800c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
12801java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
12802list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
12803of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
12804convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
12805
12806Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
12807way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
12808it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
12809
12810*** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
12811
12812You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
12813highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
12814for any mode.
12815
12816For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
12817
12818 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
12819
12820in your ~/.emacs.
12821
12822*** New faces
12823
12824Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
12825font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
12826distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
12827to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
12828
12829*** Changes to fast-lock support mode
12830
12831The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
12832cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
12833same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
12834
12835*** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
12836
12837The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
12838according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
12839the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
12840non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
12841refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
12842the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
dfd67a62 12843Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
3787e12e
GM
12844
12845This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
12846For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
12847this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
12848refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
12849containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
c7bd5d57 12850the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
3787e12e
GM
12851
12852As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
12853
12854Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
12855Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
12856Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
12857new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
12858
12859If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
12860settings.
12861
12862** Ada mode changes.
12863
12864*** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
12865If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
12866procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
12867you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
12868stubs.
12869
12870*** There are two new commands:
12871 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
12872 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
12873
12874The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
12875`ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
12876`ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
12877
12878*** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
12879is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
12880Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
12881
12882*** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
12883formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
12884places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
12885space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
12886
12887** Scheme mode changes.
12888
12889*** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
12890mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
12891for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
12892with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
12893have any effect.
12894
12895If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
12896still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
12897scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
12898variables as buffer-local variables.
12899
12900*** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
12901Use M-x dsssl-mode.
12902
12903** Changes to the emacsclient program
12904
12905*** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
12906USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
12907associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
12908can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
12909
12910*** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
12911it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
12912buffer in Emacs.
12913
12914*** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
12915use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
12916ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
12917option takes precedence.
12918
12919** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
12920constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
12921(in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
12922
12923** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
12924which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
12925the current defun.
12926
12927** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
12928following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
12929
12930** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
12931and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
12932necessary).
12933
12934** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
12935if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
12936these register values no longer become completely useless.
12937If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
12938asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
12939it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
12940
12941** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
12942example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
12943be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
12944you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
12945
12946You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
12947variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
12948file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
12949revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
12950only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
12951
12952** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
12953since it applies only to the current frame.
12954
12955** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
12956file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
12957and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
12958
12959This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
12960multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
12961variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
12962tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
12963instead of just the file you are editing.
12964
12965** RefTeX mode
12966
12967RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
12968and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
12969different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
12970multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
12971turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
12972
12973C-c ( reftex-label
12974 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
12975 knows which kind of label is needed.
12976
12977C-c ) reftex-reference
12978 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
12979 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
12980
12981C-c [ reftex-citation
12982 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
12983 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
12984
12985C-c & reftex-view-crossref
12986 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
12987
12988C-c = reftex-toc
12989 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
12990 can quickly jump to every section.
12991
12992Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
12993commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
12994Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
12995reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
12996C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
12997
12998** Changes in BibTeX mode.
12999
13000*** Info documentation is now available.
13001
13002*** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
13003both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
13004
13005*** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
13006bibtex-user-optional-fields.
13007
13008*** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
13009(use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
13010
13011*** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
13012entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
13013appropriate functions.
13014
13015*** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
3a426197 13016entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
3787e12e
GM
13017
13018*** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
13019been cleaned.
13020
13021*** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
13022bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
13023
13024*** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
13025shall be delimited.
13026
13027*** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
13028bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
13029bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
13030
13031*** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
13032field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
13033prefixed with `ALT'.
13034
13035*** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
13036bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
13037formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
13038documentation).
13039
13040*** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
13041documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
13042for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
13043
13044*** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
13045comma should be inserted at end of last field.
13046
13047*** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
13048alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
13049signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
13050
13051*** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
13052
13053*** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
13054
13055*** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
13056from alien sources.
13057
13058*** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
13059to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
13060crossref entries.
13061
13062*** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
13063region.
13064
13065*** Added support for imenu.
13066
13067*** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
13068of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
13069`compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
13070`next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
13071
13072*** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
13073from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
13074
13075** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
13076
13077** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
13078
13079** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
13080functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
13081Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
13082as an argument.
13083
13084When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
13085and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
13086
13087** browse-url changes
13088
13089*** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
13090Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
13091(browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
13092non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
13093customization variables.
13094
13095*** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
13096
13097*** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
13098lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
13099(e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
13100
13101** Changes in Ediff
13102
13103*** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
13104pops up the Info file for this command.
13105
13106*** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
13107the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
13108merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
13109directories).
13110
13111*** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
13112and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
13113files in the same directory.
13114
13115*** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
13116The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
13117related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
13118
13119** Changes in Viper
13120
13121*** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
13122*** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
13123 instead of vip-.
13124*** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
13125*** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
13126Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
13127*** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
13128*** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
13129*** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
13130color when Viper is in insert state.
13131*** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
13132Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
13133viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
13134
13135** Etags changes.
13136
13137*** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
13138default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
13139Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
13140variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
13141not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
13142
13143*** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
13144
13145*** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
13146constructs are tagged. Files are recognised by the extension .java.
13147
13148*** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
13149recognised by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
13150In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
13151
13152*** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
13153C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
13154recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
13155methods and protocols.
13156
13157*** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognised by the extension
13158.cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
13159column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
13160paragraph name.
13161
13162*** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
13163an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
13164at least M times and as many as N times.
13165
13166** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
13167in files has changed slightly.
13168
13169With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
13170time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
13171This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
13172with old time-stamp-format values.
13173
13174In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
13175(`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
13176This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
13177reasons.
13178
13179In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
13180natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
13181fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
13182(`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
13183time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
13184specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
13185
13186Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
13187case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
13188truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
13189
13190The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
13191being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
13192future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
13193recommended now will continue to work then.
13194
13195See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
13196details.
13197
13198** There are some additional major modes:
13199
13200dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
13201m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
13202meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
13203
13204** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
13205copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
13206into Emacs.
13207
13208** New Lisp packages include:
13209
13210*** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
13211
13212*** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
13213be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
13214
13215*** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
13216
13217*** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
13218in shell buffers.
13219
13220*** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
13221See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
13222and `elint-defun'.
13223
13224*** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
13225meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
13226ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
13227strings or comments.
13228
13229These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
13230abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
13231you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
13232insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
13233at these points.
13234
13235*** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
13236can visit them by short forms of their names.
13237
13238*** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
13239Emacs Lisp function at point.
13240
13241*** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
13242
13243*** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
13244switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
13245
13246*** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
13247
13248*** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
13249
13250*** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
13251
13252*** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
13253from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
13254
13255*** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
13256You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
13257inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
13258original place after inserting the copy.
13259
13260*** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
13261on the buffer.
13262
13263You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
13264velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
13265(with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
13266
13267Enable mouse-drag with:
13268 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
13269-or-
13270 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
13271
13272*** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
13273mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
13274
13275*** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
13276It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
13277
13278*** ogonek
13279
13280The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
13281Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
13282platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
13283TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
13284ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
13285prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
13286instance) and vice versa.
13287
13288To use this package load it using
13289 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
13290Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
13291 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
13292 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
13293The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
13294ways of customization in `.emacs'.
13295
13296*** Interface to ph.
13297
13298Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
13299
13300The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
13301services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
13302these servers.
13303
13304*** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
13305
13306*** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
13307You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
13308while the real cursor does not move.
13309
13310*** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
13311for visiting your favorite web sites.
13312
13313*** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
13314so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
13315
13316** movemail change
13317
13318Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
13319mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
13320supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
13321user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
13322
13323This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
05197f40 13324\f
3787e12e
GM
13325* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
13326
13327** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
13328
13329Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
13330end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
13331Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
13332file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
13333file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
13334
13335To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
13336C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
13337coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
13338specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
13339LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
13340save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
05197f40 13341\f
3787e12e
GM
13342* Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
13343
13344** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
13345Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
13346vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
13347Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
13348
13349** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
13350to start with w32- instead of win32-.
13351
13352In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
13353don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
13354"win".
13355
13356** Basic Lisp changes
13357
13358*** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
13359evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
13360
13361*** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
13362be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
13363or by the user.
13364
13365The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
13366
13367*** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
13368
13369(when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
13370(unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
13371
13372*** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
13373usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
13374its argument.
13375
13376*** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
13377
13378*** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
13379
13380*** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
13381
13382*** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
13383error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
13384include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
13385`format' function.
13386
13387*** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
13388or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
13389whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
13390
13391*** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
13392either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
13393adding one of these suffixes.
13394
13395*** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
13396which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
13397If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
13398
13399We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
13400because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
13401
13402*** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
13403
13404*** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
13405You must load the `cl' library to define it.
13406
13407*** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
13408conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
13409
13410 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
13411
13412BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
13413BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
13414
13415*** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
13416choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
13417restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
13418works using `save-current-buffer'.
13419
13420*** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
13421write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
13422of the last form.
13423
13424*** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
13425which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
13426last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
13427as the last form.
13428
13429*** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
13430characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
13431matches.
13432
13433For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
13434
13435*** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
13436with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
13437Then it returns that string.
13438
13439For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
13440
13441(with-output-to-string
13442 (princ "The buffer is ")
13443 (princ (buffer-name)))
13444
13445returns "The buffer is foo".
13446
13447** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
13448is non-nil.
13449
13450These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
13451buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
13452characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
13453
13454*** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
13455a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
13456
13457Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
13458character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
13459Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
13460position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
13461characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
13462 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
13463
13464ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
13465Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
13466non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
13467characters".
13468
13469The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
13470through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
13471"leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
13472range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
13473leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
13474
13475*** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
13476(forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
13477multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
13478character, which may be more than one buffer position.
13479
13480This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
13481always one buffer position, need to be changed.
13482
13483However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
13484
13485*** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
13486because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
13487have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
13488the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
13489guaranteed.
13490
13491*** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
13492between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
13493character).
13494
13495When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
13496
13497 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
13498 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
13499 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
13500 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
13501 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
13502
13503*** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
13504
13505*** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
13506`length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
13507more than the number of characters.
13508
13509You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
13510it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
13511\xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
13512is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
13513follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
13514newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
13515
13516*** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
13517and returns a string containing those characters.
13518
13519*** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
13520(sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
13521counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
13522character, sref signals an error.
13523
13524*** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
13525in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
13526string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13527
13528*** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
13529in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
13530region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13531
13532*** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
13533the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
13534to a vector of the characters in it.
13535
13536*** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
13537of a string. You call it as follows:
13538
13539 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
13540
13541This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
13542STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
13543This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
13544Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
13545it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
13546
13547*** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
13548if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13549
13550*** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
13551if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13552
13553*** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
13554to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
13555not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
13556which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
13557
13558(truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
13559
13560This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
13561
13562The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
13563If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
13564are not included in the resulting value.
13565
13566The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
13567at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
13568WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
13569is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
13570
13571If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
13572place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
13573character extends across that column), then the padding character
13574PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
13575string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
13576column START-COLUMN.
13577
13578*** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
13579the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
13580necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
13581difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
13582changed text, before the change.
13583
13584*** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
13585sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
13586one character set for each script, not for each language.
13587
13588**** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
13589
13590**** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
13591
13592**** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
13593set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
13594
13595**** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
13596name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
13597which identify the character within that character set.
13598
13599**** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
13600byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
13601opposite of split-char.
13602
13603**** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
13604of all the characters between BEG and END.
13605
13606**** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
13607of all the characters in a string.
13608
13609*** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
13610and specifying coding systems.
13611
13612**** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
13613system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
13614of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
13615(Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
13616and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
13617as what to do about code conversion.)
13618
13619**** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
13620name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
13621
13622**** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13623for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13624except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
13625
13626Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13627which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
13628to match against a file name.
13629
13630VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13631a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13632decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13633to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13634systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13635specifies the coding system for encoding.
13636
13637If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13638or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13639
13640**** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
13641the coding system to use for network sockets.
13642
13643Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13644which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
13645either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
13646service names.
13647
13648VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13649a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13650decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13651to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13652systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13653specifies the coding system for encoding.
13654
13655If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13656or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13657
13658**** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13659for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13660except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
13661start the subprocess.
13662
13663**** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
13664systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
13665when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
13666(OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
13667to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
13668
13669**** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
13670coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
13671subprocess.
13672
13673It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
13674but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
13675start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
13676connection permanently or until overridden.
13677
13678The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
13679file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
13680network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
13681coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
13682It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
13683system for one operation at a time.
13684
13685**** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
13686files, subprocesses or network connections.
13687
13688**** The function process-coding-system tells you what
13689coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
13690The value is a cons cell,
13691 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
13692where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
13693the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
13694input to the subprocess.
13695
13696**** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
13697change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
13698
13699** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
13700customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
13701you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
13702
13703You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
13704variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
13705information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
13706legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
13707customization.
13708
13709Thus, instead of writing
13710
13711 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
13712 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
13713
13714you would now write this:
13715
13716 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
13717 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
13718 :type 'boolean
13719 :group foo)
13720
13721The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
13722two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
13723describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
13724for a description of them.
13725
13726The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
13727should belong to. You define a new group like this:
13728
13729 (defgroup ispell nil
13730 "Spell checking using Ispell."
13731 :group 'processes)
13732
13733The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
13734group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
13735but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
13736to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
13737second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
13738
13739Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
13740package should have just one group; a more complex package should
13741have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
13742package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
13743first-level subgroups.
13744
13745** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
13746
13747This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
13748separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
13749
13750** easy-mmode
13751
13752The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
13753developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
13754only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
13755predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
13756`easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
13757`easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
13758
13759** Text property changes
13760
13761*** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
13762text property.
13763
13764*** The new functions next-char-property-change and
13765previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
13766place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
13767functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
13768starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
13769
13770If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
13771LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
13772of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
13773position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
13774
13775*** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
13776value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
13777is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
13778
13779** Changes in invisibility features
13780
13781*** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
13782hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
13783is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
13784should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
13785would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
13786make the overlay visible.
13787
13788During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
13789invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
13790needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
13791which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
13792the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
13793t when it should hide it.
13794
13795*** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
13796
13797Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
13798invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
13799and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
13800Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
13801manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
13802Here is an example of how to do this:
13803
13804 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
13805 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13806 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
13807 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13808
13809 ...
13810 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
13811
13812 ...
13813 ;; When done with the overlays:
13814 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13815 ;; Or respectively:
13816 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13817
13818** Changes in syntax parsing.
13819
13820*** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
13821`parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
13822obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
13823`parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
13824
13825If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
13826is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
13827used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
13828
13829When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
13830character in the buffer is calculated thus:
13831
13832 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
13833 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
13834
13835 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
13836 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
13837 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
13838
13839 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
13840 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
13841 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
13842 determine the syntax type of the character.
13843
13844 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
13845 of the current buffer.
13846
13847*** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
13848value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
13849for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
13850
13851*** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
13852and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
13853only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
13854character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
13855another character with the same code (unless quoted).
13856
13857These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
13858text property.
13859
13860*** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
13861arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
13862of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
13863
13864*** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
13865(and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
13866element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
13867nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
13868string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
13869
13870*** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
13871syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
13872`font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
13873
13874** Changes in face features
13875
13876*** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
13877if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
13878
13879*** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
13880of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
13881
13882*** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
13883set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
13884
13885*** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
13886set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
13887
13888*** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
13889by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
13890and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
13891the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
13892overlay property).
13893
13894This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
13895arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
13896
13897** Changes in file-handling functions
13898
13899*** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
13900directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
13901they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
13902is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
13903
13904This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
13905begins with ~.
13906
13907*** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
13908it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
13909
13910*** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
13911the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
13912
13913*** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
13914as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
13915
13916*** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
13917character code conversion as well as other things.
13918
13919Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
13920(formerly it did not).
13921
13922*** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
13923environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
13924
13925*** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
13926instead of constant strings.
13927
13928*** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
13929to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
13930any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
13931
13932substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
13933in the same way as before.
13934
13935*** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
13936The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
13937which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
13938
13939*** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
13940error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
13941else, and returns nil.
13942
13943*** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
13944directory cannot be listed.
13945
13946** Changes in minibuffer input
13947
13948*** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
13949read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
13950additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
13951argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
13952ways:
13953
13954 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
13955 It is available through the history command M-n.
13956
13957*** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
13958read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
13959argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
13960minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
13961enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
13962
13963In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
13964argument in this way.
13965
13966*** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
13967from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
13968minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
13969
13970** Echo area features
13971
13972*** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
13973echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
13974minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
13975after the echo area is cleared.
13976
13977*** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
13978in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
13979
13980** Keyboard input features
13981
13982*** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
13983set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
13984
13985*** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
13986received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
13987by keyboard macros.
13988
13989** Frame-related changes
13990
13991*** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
13992creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
13993hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
13994
13995*** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
13996the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
13997has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
13998
13999*** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
14000selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
14001value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
14002in the selected frame.
14003
14004*** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
14005is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
14006which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
14007
14008** X Windows features
14009
14010*** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
14011x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
14012x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
14013
14014*** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
14015The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
14016
14017*** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
14018MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
14019A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
14020
14021If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
14022it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
14023
14024** Subprocess features
14025
14026*** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
14027functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
14028automatically.
14029
14030*** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
14031and returns the output from the command as a string.
14032
14033*** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
14034and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
14035
14036** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
14037does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
14038
14039** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
14040at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
14041goes after the other menu items.
14042
14043** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
14044of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
14045around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
14046are in use.
14047
14048The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
14049series of several changes--if that seems safe.
14050
14051Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
14052after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
14053form.
14054
14055** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
14056is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
14057but its hook is still run.
14058
14059** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
14060for errors that are handled by condition-case.
14061
14062If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
14063regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
14064useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
14065
14066This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
14067are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
14068filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
14069warned.
14070
14071** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
14072way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
14073
14074** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
14075integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
14076functions like display-time.
14077
14078** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
14079name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
14080
14081** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
14082can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
14083is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
14084
14085** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
14086if there is an error in compilation.
14087
14088** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
14089switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
14090argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
14091they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
14092
14093** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
14094Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
14095the *scratch* buffer.
14096
14097** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
14098The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
14099where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
14100e.g., in Font Lock mode.
14101
14102** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
14103and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
14104It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
14105
14106** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
14107using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
14108variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
14109and compose-mail-other-frame.
14110
14111** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
14112can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
14113full name of the specified user will be returned.
14114
14115** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
14116of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
14117where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
14118in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
14119option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
14120files at all.
14121
14122** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
14123and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
14124width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
14125the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
14126
14127For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
14128minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
14129with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
14130is how %S normally pads to two positions.
14131
14132** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
14133
14134** imenu.el changes.
14135
14136You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
14137item from menu created by imenu.
14138
14139An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
14140#include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
14141select one of those items.
05197f40 14142\f
3787e12e 14143* For older news, see the file ONEWS
a933dad1
DL
14144
14145----------------------------------------------------------------------
14146Copyright information:
14147
175573ac 14148Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
a933dad1
DL
14149
14150 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
14151 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
14152 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
14153 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
14154
14155 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
14156 of this document, or of portions of it,
14157 under the above conditions, provided also that they
14158 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
05197f40 14159\f
a933dad1
DL
14160Local variables:
14161mode: outline
14162paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
14163end:
ab5796a9
MB
14164
14165arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793